Nothing Special   »   [go: up one dir, main page]

WO2019108982A1 - Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof - Google Patents

Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2019108982A1
WO2019108982A1 PCT/US2018/063389 US2018063389W WO2019108982A1 WO 2019108982 A1 WO2019108982 A1 WO 2019108982A1 US 2018063389 W US2018063389 W US 2018063389W WO 2019108982 A1 WO2019108982 A1 WO 2019108982A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
benzoxaborole
group
formulation
composition
alkyl
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2018/063389
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Marissa AUBREY
Chun Yu LIU
Chunliang Liu
Michael Samuels
Yong-Kang Zhang
Yasheen Zhou
Original Assignee
Boragen, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Boragen, Inc. filed Critical Boragen, Inc.
Priority to JP2020548880A priority Critical patent/JP2021505660A/en
Priority to BR112020010927-4A priority patent/BR112020010927A2/en
Priority to CA3120976A priority patent/CA3120976A1/en
Priority to MX2020005464A priority patent/MX2020005464A/en
Priority to US15/733,157 priority patent/US11834466B2/en
Priority to AU2018375795A priority patent/AU2018375795A1/en
Priority to CN201880088201.8A priority patent/CN111655035A/en
Priority to EP18883841.1A priority patent/EP3716766A4/en
Publication of WO2019108982A1 publication Critical patent/WO2019108982A1/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07FACYCLIC, CARBOCYCLIC OR HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS CONTAINING ELEMENTS OTHER THAN CARBON, HYDROGEN, HALOGEN, OXYGEN, NITROGEN, SULFUR, SELENIUM OR TELLURIUM
    • C07F5/00Compounds containing elements of Groups 3 or 13 of the Periodic Table
    • C07F5/02Boron compounds
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A01AGRICULTURE; FORESTRY; ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; HUNTING; TRAPPING; FISHING
    • A01NPRESERVATION OF BODIES OF HUMANS OR ANIMALS OR PLANTS OR PARTS THEREOF; BIOCIDES, e.g. AS DISINFECTANTS, AS PESTICIDES OR AS HERBICIDES; PEST REPELLANTS OR ATTRACTANTS; PLANT GROWTH REGULATORS
    • A01N55/00Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, containing organic compounds containing elements other than carbon, hydrogen, halogen, oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur
    • A01N55/08Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, containing organic compounds containing elements other than carbon, hydrogen, halogen, oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur containing boron
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A01AGRICULTURE; FORESTRY; ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; HUNTING; TRAPPING; FISHING
    • A01NPRESERVATION OF BODIES OF HUMANS OR ANIMALS OR PLANTS OR PARTS THEREOF; BIOCIDES, e.g. AS DISINFECTANTS, AS PESTICIDES OR AS HERBICIDES; PEST REPELLANTS OR ATTRACTANTS; PLANT GROWTH REGULATORS
    • A01N25/00Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, characterised by their forms, or by their non-active ingredients or by their methods of application, e.g. seed treatment or sequential application; Substances for reducing the noxious effect of the active ingredients to organisms other than pests
    • A01N25/02Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, characterised by their forms, or by their non-active ingredients or by their methods of application, e.g. seed treatment or sequential application; Substances for reducing the noxious effect of the active ingredients to organisms other than pests containing liquids as carriers, diluents or solvents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A01AGRICULTURE; FORESTRY; ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; HUNTING; TRAPPING; FISHING
    • A01NPRESERVATION OF BODIES OF HUMANS OR ANIMALS OR PLANTS OR PARTS THEREOF; BIOCIDES, e.g. AS DISINFECTANTS, AS PESTICIDES OR AS HERBICIDES; PEST REPELLANTS OR ATTRACTANTS; PLANT GROWTH REGULATORS
    • A01N25/00Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, characterised by their forms, or by their non-active ingredients or by their methods of application, e.g. seed treatment or sequential application; Substances for reducing the noxious effect of the active ingredients to organisms other than pests
    • A01N25/02Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, characterised by their forms, or by their non-active ingredients or by their methods of application, e.g. seed treatment or sequential application; Substances for reducing the noxious effect of the active ingredients to organisms other than pests containing liquids as carriers, diluents or solvents
    • A01N25/04Dispersions, emulsions, suspoemulsions, suspension concentrates or gels
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A01AGRICULTURE; FORESTRY; ANIMAL HUSBANDRY; HUNTING; TRAPPING; FISHING
    • A01NPRESERVATION OF BODIES OF HUMANS OR ANIMALS OR PLANTS OR PARTS THEREOF; BIOCIDES, e.g. AS DISINFECTANTS, AS PESTICIDES OR AS HERBICIDES; PEST REPELLANTS OR ATTRACTANTS; PLANT GROWTH REGULATORS
    • A01N25/00Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, characterised by their forms, or by their non-active ingredients or by their methods of application, e.g. seed treatment or sequential application; Substances for reducing the noxious effect of the active ingredients to organisms other than pests
    • A01N25/08Biocides, pest repellants or attractants, or plant growth regulators, characterised by their forms, or by their non-active ingredients or by their methods of application, e.g. seed treatment or sequential application; Substances for reducing the noxious effect of the active ingredients to organisms other than pests containing solids as carriers or diluents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/69Boron compounds
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07FACYCLIC, CARBOCYCLIC OR HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS CONTAINING ELEMENTS OTHER THAN CARBON, HYDROGEN, HALOGEN, OXYGEN, NITROGEN, SULFUR, SELENIUM OR TELLURIUM
    • C07F5/00Compounds containing elements of Groups 3 or 13 of the Periodic Table
    • C07F5/02Boron compounds
    • C07F5/025Boronic and borinic acid compounds

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to benzoxaborole compounds and to formulations of benzoxaborole compounds comprising surfactants and/or suitable carriers for agricultural or therapeutic use (e.g., as phytopathogenic and/or infectious agent control, growth enhancement or control).
  • the invention also relates to methods of using the benzoxaborole compounds and the formulations thereof.
  • Boron is a unique, and often misconstrued, element of the periodic table due to its powerfully effective and potentially high toxicological properties.
  • Initial innovation in the field of boron chemistry was impaired due to the incapacity to prepare pure boron, especially in its crystalline form.
  • Early characterization of boron-containing molecules was also stymied by contamination of that crystalline form by aluminum. While the use of boron, in the form of boric acid, is well known for its use in agriculture, the construction and characterization of more complex boron-containing molecules that are both safe and effective has been relatively unexplored. Only recently has boron been explored by skilled organo -metallic chemists for novel and useful applications across human/animal health and agriculture.
  • boron- containing molecules such as oxaboroles and benzoxaboroles demonstrate use as antimicrobials, antiparasitics, and antifungals.
  • oxaboroles and benzoxaboroles demonstrate use as antimicrobials, antiparasitics, and antifungals.
  • Patent No. 9,617,285 (antiparasitic), and Publication No. WO2016164589 (antifungal)).
  • boron-containing scaffolds present compounds that must be tested from a toxicology, mode of action, and activity perspective. Moreover, once the target compounds are made and tested, formulation of those compounds can be laborious due to issues such as pKa, pH, and solubility. The duplicitous nature of boron-containing compounds places their activity on a broad continuum; including those that are highly toxic, and those that are exceptionally benign. Thus, creation of novel and useful boron-containing compounds requires skilled attention to design, synthesis, formulation, as well as thoughtful screening to determine toxicity, mode of action, and efficacy.
  • Antifungals, insecticides, and pesticides are costly to both purchase and use, as well as often being toxic and/or otherwise detrimental to off-target vegetation near the site of application including runoff, affecting the watershed. Moreover, many antifungals, insecticides, and pesticides lose efficacy over time, concomitantly with pathogens becoming resistant to treatment. It is beneficial to farmers, consumers, and their surrounding communities to use the minimum required dose of antifungals, insecticides, and/or pesticides to achieve maximum crop yield, while mitigating onset of resistance and environmental detriment.
  • benzoxaboroles While some benzoxaboroles have been demonstrated to exhibit antibacterial and antifungal activities, they have not been successfully employed as a commercial product for crop protection and agricultural pest-control. One reason may be the fluxional and reactive nature of benzoxaboroles. Benzoxaboroles can exist in a neutral trigonal planar geometry, an ionic tetrahedral geometry, or a mixture of both of these geometries depending on the specific environment of the benzoxaborole. Specifically, solvents, surfactants, stabilizers, antioxidants, pH, and other adjuvants commonly used as formulation ingredients can easily alter the
  • benzoxaborole s geometry, formal charge (neutral trigonal or ionic tetrahedral) and
  • the benzoxaborole can ultimately be an effective, potent compound, or a compound that shows little or no bioactivity.
  • neutral trigonal planar benzoxaborole and ionic tetrahedral benzoxaborole each have unique physical chemical properties that are important to consider to develop an efficacious formulation of the benzoxaborole (e.g. solubility, stability, and pH).
  • control e.g., curative, inhibitive, ameliorative, and/or preventative activity
  • the compounds described herein when applied to plants, seeds, plant parts, harvested fruits, vegetables and/or plant’s locus of growth allows for effective control of pathogenic microorganisms, fungi, bacteria, and other phytopathogens.
  • the formulation of traditional, non-boron containing, organic active ingredients can be predicted by the physical characteristics of the overall molecule (logP, melting point, solubility, compound polarity, etc)
  • the formulation of benzoxaboroles has an aspect of unpredictability - the formulation of the relatively reactive benzoxaborole functional group.
  • the charge and geometry of the benzoxaborole is not static. Rather, the benzoxaborole can exist in a fluxional state, wherein the compound is in a dynamic equilibrium between the neutral, trigonal planar state and the ionic, trigonal planar state (Scheme 1). Additionally, substitutions on the benzoxaborole can have profound effects on this dynamic equilibrium.
  • benzoxaboroles are primarily organic (easier to dissolve in organic solvents than in more water-like solvents) in nature due to being composed of predominately
  • hydrocarbons However, they also possess a relatively polar boron-hydroxyl group in the overall chemical structure, and the boron-hydroxyl group prefers to be in more water-like solvent.
  • the boron atom has an empty p-orbital, which readily forms covalent bonds with Lewis bases that may be present in the formulation (potentially affecting biological activity).
  • the empty p-orbital on the boron of the benzoxaborole makes formulation of
  • benzoxaborole active ingredients unpredictable and difficult relative to traditional, non-boron containing, organic molecules.
  • This Lewis acidic center readily interacts with formulation components (solvents, surfactants, and other adjuvants) in unexpected ways. Accordingly, the formulation of benzoxaborole active ingredients requires novel approaches that heretofore have not been developed or considered for the formulation of traditional, non-boron containing agricultural or therapeutic formulations.
  • a benzoxaborole formulation composition comprises a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
  • the carrier is a solid or a liquid.
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • the benzoxaborole may be a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer of the compound of structure (lb).
  • the benzoxaborole has a structure (Ic):
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • the benzoxaborole may be a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer of the compound of structure (Ic).
  • Y can be selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, and hydrogen.
  • benzoxaborole is:
  • the non-ionic and ionic surfactants are independently selected from the group consisting of: high molecular weight polymers, polycondensates of ethylene oxide with fatty alcohols or with fatty acids or with fatty amines, substituted phenols (in particular alkylphenols or arylphenols such as mono- and di-(polyoxyalkylene alkylphenol), polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphate tristyrylphenols and polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphoric esters of alcohols or phenols, amine ethoxylates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil, sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, sorbitan monolaurate, sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan monolaurates
  • the pKa of the benzoxaborole is between 6 and 10, preferably between 6 and 8.
  • benzoxaborole formulation is 5% to 60% w/w if the carrier is a liquid, and the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 20% to 99.9% w/w if the carrier is a solid.
  • the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 10% to 50% w/w if the carrier is a liquid, and the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the
  • benzoxaborole formulation is 20% to 80% w/w if the carrier is a solid.
  • benzoxaborole formulation is between 0.1% and 35% w/w.
  • the composition further comprises an antioxidant.
  • the carrier is a liquid and comprises a solvent selected from the group consisting of: a protic solvent, water, C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof, alcohols, ethylene glycol monomethyl ether, or a mixture thereof.
  • a solvent selected from the group consisting of: a protic solvent, water, C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -
  • the carrier further comprises a second liquid carrier selected from the group consisting of: an aprotic solvent, a ketone, cyclohexanone, isophorone, or N- methyl-2-pyrrolidone.
  • the carrier may comprise a mixture of a protic solvent and an aprotic solvent, preferably the aprotic solvent is polar. Morever, the carrier may be a solid.
  • the benzoxaborole formulation is an emulsion concentrate (EC), a suspension concentrate (SC), a wettable powder (WP), a water dispersible granule (WDG), or a seed treatment.
  • the formulation composition may further comprise an aqueous diluent.
  • the aqueous diluent may have a pH between about 5.5 and 9.5, for example, between about 6 and 8.
  • the composition further comprises at least one fungicide selected from the group consisting of: carbendazim, thiabendazole, thiophanate, thiophanate- methyl, diethofencarb, zoxamide, ethaboxam, pencycuron, flupicolide, flutolanil, fluopyram, fluxapyroxad, penthiopyrad, benodanil, mepronil, isofetamid, fenfuram, carboxin, oxycarboxin, thifluzamide, benzovindiflupyr, bixafen, furametpyr, isopyrazam, penflufen, sedaxane, boscalid, benomyl, fuberidazole, diflumetorim, tolfenpyrad, azoxystrobin, coumoxystrobin, enoxastrobin, flufenoxystrobin, picoxystrobin, pyraoxystrobin, man
  • the composition further comprises at least one insecticide/nematicide selected from the group consisting of: avermectin group, such as abamectin; carbamate group, such as, aldicarb, thiadicarb, carbofuran, carbosulfan, oxamyl, aldoxycarb, ethoprop, methomyl, benomyl, alanycarb; and organophosphorus group, such as, fenamiphos, fensulfothion, terbufos, fosthiazate, dimethoate, phosphocarb, dichlofenthion, isamidofos, fosthietan, isazofos ethoprophos, cadusafos, terbufos, chlorpyrifos, dichlofenthion, heterophos, isamidofos, mecarphon, phorate, thionazin, triazo
  • the composition may comprise at least one insecticide selected from the group consisting of: a phenylpyrazole group, such as ethiprole and fipronil; a pyrethroid group, such as acrinathrin, allethrin, bifenthrin, bioallenthrin, bioresmethrin, cycloprothrin, cyfluthrin, cyhalothrin, cypermethrin, cyphenothrin, deltamethrin, esfenvalerate, etofenprox, fenpropathrin, fenvalerate, flucythrinate, flumethrin, halfenprox, imiprothrin, kadethrin, permethrin, prallethrin, pyrethrins, resmethrin, silafluofen, tefluthrin, tetramethrin,
  • a method of controlling a phytopathogenic disease on crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material comprises applying an effective amount of the composition of the first aspect to said crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material.
  • a method of controlling a phytopathogenic disease on crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material comprises applying an effective amount of the composition of the first aspect, wherein said application is topical, to the soil, foliar, a foliar spray, systemic, a seed coating, a soil drench, directly in-furrow dipping, drenching, soil drenching, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), and/or drip irrigating.
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH 3 , CF 3 , Ethyl, OCH 3 , OCF 3 , OCF 2 H, CFFh, OEthyl, O-n-propyl, O-n-butyl, O-iso- propyl, O-sec -butyl, O-iso-butyl, O-cyclopropyl, O-cyclbutyl, C(0)H, CN, CH 2 OH, SR 1 , and S(0)R 1 , wherein R 1 is selected from C1-C3
  • X is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, R 2 , OR 2 , OCF 2 H, NR 2 2, NHR 2 , NH 2 , halogen, CO2R 2 , CN, OH, CH 2 OH, N0 2 , C(0)H, SR 2 , and S(0)R 2 , wherein each R 2 is independently selected from C1-C7
  • hydrocarbyl and C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl or each R 2 can be taken together to form a ring;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH 3 , NO2, C(0)H, and CO2R 3 , wherein R 3 is selected from C1-C4 hydrocarbyl and C3-C4 cyclohydrocarbyl;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, R 4 , NR 4 2, NHR 4 , NH 2 , NO2, CO2R 4 , OR 4 , OH, OCF2H, SR 4 , and S(0)R 4 , wherein R 4 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl and C3 cyclohydrocarbyl; and
  • V and V’ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and
  • a benzoxaborole compound is represented by formula Ial:
  • Ri is equal to R 2 , or Ri is not equal to R 2 , and
  • Ri and/or R 2 are selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, and pentyl, or
  • Ri and R 2 are taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring; and each X a is independently selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
  • a benzoxaborole compound is represented by formula Iall:
  • each R 12 or R 13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl, C3-C6 cyclohydrocabyl, -CH 2 CoCR 4 a , - CH 2 CoCPh, CH 2 CoCCH 2 Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R 4 a substitutions; or R 12 and R 13 taken together, form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; each X a is independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; each Y a is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; and each R 4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt,
  • the benzoxaborole compound is selected from the group consisting of:
  • At least one of R 12 and R 13 is -CH 2 CoCR 4 a , wherein R 4 a is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl.
  • at least one of R 12 and R 13 is -CH 2 CoCPh or CH 2 CoCCH 2 Ph.
  • the compound is selected from the group consisting of:
  • an emulsion concentrate formulation composition comprises a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a liquid carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the liquid carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
  • the benzoxaborole is:
  • the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent.
  • the liquid carrier may comprise a mixture of a protic solvent and an aprotic solvent.
  • the aprotic solvent may be a polar aprotic solvent or a non-polar aprotic solvent.
  • a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen comprises applying a compound according to any aspect of the invention, wherein the pathogen is selected from a group consisting of: insects, nematodes, bacteria, microbes, fungi, protozoa, viruses, and parasites, or any combinations thereof.
  • the compound may be applied to an animal, a plant, a plant part, seeds, or plant propagation material.
  • FIG. 1 is an image of the 'H-NMR spectra recorded in association with Example 22 of the formulation examples.
  • FIG. 2A-2I is a table that provides chemical characterization data for a number of exemplary benzoxaborole compounds, including some of those for which synthesis is described in the Syntheses Examples Section.
  • FIG. 3A-3TT is a table showing antifungal and antibacterial inhibition results for a number of exemplary boron-based compounds as described in Example 3 and Example 4 of the Biological Materials and Methods examples.
  • each of the expressions“at least one of A, B and C”,“at least one of A, B, or C”,“one or more of A, B, and C”,“one or more of A, B, or C” and“A, B, and/or C” means A alone, B alone, C alone, A and B together, A and C together, B and C together, or A, B and C together.
  • the term“a” or“an” entity refers to one or more of that entity.
  • the terms“a” (or“an”),“one or more” and“at least one” can be used interchangeably herein.
  • the terms“comprising”,“including”, and“having” can be used interchangeably.
  • hydrocarbyl is a short hand term for a non-aromatic group that includes straight and branched chain aliphatic as well as alicyclic groups or radicals that contain only carbon and hydrogen. Inasmuch as alicyclic groups are cyclic aliphatic groups, such substituents are deemed to be subsumed within the aliphatic groups. Thus, alkyl, alkenyl, and alkynyl groups are contemplated.
  • hydrocarbyl groups contain a chain of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, and more preferably 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • hydrocarbyl radicals include methyl, ethyl, n- propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, sec butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl, iso-amyl, hexyl, and the like.
  • alkenyl radicals examples include ethenyl (vinyl), 2 propenyl, 3 propenyl, 1,4- pentadienyl, 1,4 butadienyl, l-butenyl, 2-butenyl, 3-butenyl, and the like.
  • alkynyl radicals include ethynyl, 2-prop ynyl, 3 propynyl, decynyl, 1 butynyl, 2-butynyl, 3-butynyl, and the like.
  • An alkyl group is a preferred hydrocarbyl group.
  • a contemplated cyclohydrocarbyl substituent ring contains 3 to 6 carbon atoms.
  • cycloalkylalkyl means an alkyl radical as defined above that is substituted by a cycloalkyl radical. Examples of such cycloalkyl radicals include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, and the like.
  • hydrocarbyl ether is referred to as a "hydrocarbyloxy” group rather than a "hydrocarboxy” group as may possibly be more proper when following the usual rules of chemical nomenclature.
  • Illustrative hydrocarbyloxy groups include methoxy, ethoxy, and cyclohexenyloxy groups.
  • hydrocarbyl group containing a C(O)- functionality is referred to as a hydrocarboyl (acyl) and that containing a -C(0)0- is a hydrocarboyloxy group inasmuch as there is no ambiguity.
  • exemplary hydrocarboyl and hydrocarboyloxy groups include acyl and acyloxy groups, respectively, such as formyl, acetyl, propionyl, butyryl, valeryl, 4 methylvaleryl, and acetoxy, acryloyl, and acryloyloxy.
  • halogen or“halo” means fluorine, chlorine, bromine, or iodine.
  • halohydrocarbyl means a hydrocarbyl radical as defined above wherein one or more hydrogens is replaced with a halogen.
  • a halohydrocarbyl radical (group or substituent) is typically a substituted alkyl substituent. Examples of such haloalkyl radicals include chloromethyl, 1- bromoethyl, fluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, l,l,l-trifluoroethyl, and the like.
  • perfluorohydrocarbyl means an alkyl group wherein each hydrogen has been replaced by a fluorine atom.
  • perfluorohydrocarbyl groups in addition to trifluoromethyl above, are perfluorobutyl, perfluoroisopropyl, and perfluorohexyl.
  • the abbreviation“Ph” means a phenyl group (C6H5) group.
  • the phrase“True Fungi” is used herein for all of the fungal organisms discussed herein except for the Oomycota (such as Pythium, Phytophthora and Plasmopara).
  • the uncaptialized term“fungi” or“fungus” is used to include all of the fungal organisms discussed herein, including the Oomycota.
  • “pesticidal” means the ability of a substance to increase mortality, inhibit the growth rate, or eliminate the presence of plant pests.
  • the term is used herein, to describe the property of a substance to exhibit activity against insects, mites, nematodes, fungi, bacteria, viruses, and/or phytopathogens.
  • the term“pests” include insects, mites, nematodes, fungi, bacteria, viruses, and/or phytopathogens.
  • the term "health of a plant” or "plant health” is defined as a condition of the plant and/or its products. As a result of the improved health, yield, plant vigor, quality and tolerance to abiotic or biotic stress are increased.
  • the health of a plant, when applying the active ingredients described herein, is increased independently of the pesticidal properties of the active ingredients used because the increase in health is not only based upon the reduced pest pressure but also on complex physiological and metabolic reactions that result, for example, in an activation of the plant's own natural defense system. As a result, the health of a plant is increased even in the absence of pest pressure.
  • insects as well as the term“insecticidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality or inhibit growth rate of insects.
  • the term“insects” includes all organisms in the class“Insecta.”
  • pre-adult insects refers to any form of an organism prior to the adult stage, including, for example, eggs, larvae, and nymphs.
  • Nematicides and“nematicidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality or inhibit the growth rate of nematodes.
  • the term“nematode” comprises eggs, larvae, juvenile, and mature forms of said organism.
  • Acaricide and“acaricidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality or inhibit growth rate of ectoparasites belonging to the class Arachnida, sub-class Acari.
  • Fungicide and“fungicidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality, control or inhibit growth rate of Fungi. Fungicidal abilities may be preventative, curative, or a combination thereof.
  • By“effective” amount of an active ingredient, compound, drug, formulation, or permeant is meant a sufficient amount of an active agent to provide the desired local or systemic effect.
  • A“topically effective” or“therapeutically effective” amount refers to the amount of compound or drug needed to effect the desired therapeutic result.
  • the term“agriculturally acceptable salt” is meant to include a salt of a compound of the invention which are prepared with relatively nontoxic acids or bases, depending on the particular substituents found on the compounds described herein.
  • base addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired base, either neat or in a suitable inert carrier.
  • Examples of agriculturally acceptable base addition salts include sodium, potassium, calcium, ammonium, organic amino (such as choline or diethylamine or amino acids such as d-arginine, l-arginine, d-lysine, or l-lysine), or magnesium salt, or a similar salt.
  • acid addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired acid, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent.
  • suitable inert solvent examples include those derived from inorganic acids like hydrochloric, hydrobromic, nitric, carbonic, monohydrogencarbonic, phosphoric, monohydrogenphosphoric,
  • salts of amino acids such as arginate and the like, and salts of organic acids like glucuronic or galactunoric acids and the like (see, for example, Berge et ah,“Pharmaceutical Salts”, Journal of Pharmaceutical Science 66: 1-19 (1977)).
  • Certain specific compounds of the invention contain both basic and acidic functionalities that allow the compounds to be converted into either base or acid addition salts.
  • the term“agriculturally acceptable excipient” is conventionally known to mean agriculturally acceptable carriers, agriculturally acceptable diluents and/or agriculturally acceptable vehicles used in formulating compositions effective for the desired use.
  • the term“agriculturally acceptable carrier” or“agriculturally acceptable vehicle” or “carrier” refers to any medium that provides the appropriate delivery of an effective amount of an active agent(s) as defined herein, does not negatively interfere with the effectiveness of the biological activity of the active agent, and that is sufficiently non-toxic to the host.
  • the term is used herein to denote a natural or synthetic, organic, or inorganic material that constitutes a portion of the diluent medium in which the benzoxaborole is dispersed or dissolved.
  • a carrier, agriculturally acceptable carrier, or agriculturally acceptable vehicle can be solid (clays, natural or synthetic silicates, silica, resins, waxes, solid fertilizers, and the like) or liquid (water, alcohols, ketones, petroleum fractions, aromatic or paraffinic hydrocarbons, chlorinated hydrocarbons, liquefied gases, and the like).
  • carriers may be solid or liquid, and may comprise a Lewis base, or a N-H or O-H bond. Additional information concerning carriers can be found in Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 21 st Ed., Lippincott, Williams & Wilkins (2005), which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • formulation refers to a mixture that may be solid or liquid comprising a benzoxaborole and at least one of agriculturally acceptable carriers, solvents, adjuvants, wetting agents, surfactants, and the like.
  • formulation refers both to concentrated
  • formulations include: wettable powders (WP), water dispersible granules (WG or WDG), soluble concentrates (SL), suspension concentrates (SC), emulsifiable/emulsion-concentrates (EC), concentrated aqueous emulsions (EW),
  • microemulsions ME
  • suspoemulsion SE
  • oil dispersions OD
  • microencapuslted particles CS
  • soil applied granule on inters or fertilizer carriers GR
  • seed treatments pre-mixes, tank- mixes, dosage formulations, etc.
  • the term“surfactant” or“surfactants” generally refers to compounds or substances that lower surface tension between between two liquids, a gas and a liquid, or a liquid and a solid. Surfactants generally may act as surface active agents, wetting agents, dispersing agents, other adjuvants, and the like.
  • the term“Lewis Acid” refers to a compound or ionic species that can accept an electron pair from a donor compound (for example, a Lewis Base). A Lewis Acid is capable of accepting an electron pair from a Lewis Base to form a Lewis adduct.
  • Lewis Base refers to a compound or ionic species that can donate an electron pair to an acceptor compound (for example, a Lewis Acid).
  • a Lewis Base is capable of donating an electron pair to a Lewis Acid to form a Lewis adduct.
  • Benzoxaborole compounds and methods of using the benzoxaborole compounds are described herein. As will be discussed in greater detail below, exemplary embodiments of the compound are particularly useful in agricultural or therapeutic applications (e.g., as
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (I):
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH 3 , CF 3 , Et,
  • X is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, R 2 , OR 2 , OCF 2 H, NR 2 2 , NHR 2 , NH 2 , halogen, C0 2 R 2 , CN, OH, CH 2 OH, N0 2 , C(0)H, SR 2 , and S(0)R 2 , wherein each R 2 is independently selected from C1-C7 hydrocarbyl and C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl or each R 2 can be taken together to form a ring; Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH 3 , N0 2 , C(0)H, and CO2R 3 , wherein R 3 is selected from C1-C4 hydrocarbyl and C3-C4 cyclohydrocarbyl;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, R 4 , NR 4 2 , NHR 4 , NH 2 , N0 2 , C0 2 R 4 , OR 4 , OH, OCF I H, SR 4 , and S(0)R 4 , wherein R 4 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl and C3 cyclohydrocarbyl; and
  • V and V’ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and
  • Exemplary embodiments of the benzoxaborole compound include the following:
  • the above exemplary embodiments may also be or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Ial):
  • Ri is equal to R 2 , or Ri is not equal to R 2 , and
  • Ri and/or R 2 are selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, and pentyl, or
  • Ri and R 2 are taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring, and each X a is independently selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Iall):
  • each R 12 or R 13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl, C3-C6 cyclohydrocabyl, -CH 2 CoCR 4 a , CH 2 CoCPh, CH 2 CoCCH 2 Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R 4 a substitutions; or R 12 and R 13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to;
  • X a is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine;
  • Y a is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and each R 4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula
  • each R 12 or R 13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl , C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl, -CH 2 Co CR 4 a , CH 2 CoCPh, CH 2 CoCCH 2 Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R 4 a substitutions; or R 12 and R 13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; and each R 4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of: alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (IalV):
  • each R 12 or R 13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl , C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl, -CH2CoCR 4 a , CH 2 CoCPh CH 2 CoCCH 2 Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R 4 a substitutions; or R 12 and R 13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; each R 4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
  • the disclosure includes a benzoxaborole formula (IaV):
  • each R 12 or R 13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl, C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl, -CH 2 CoCR 4 a , CH 2 CoCPh, CH 2 CoCCH 2 Ph and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R 4 a substitutions; or R 12 and R 13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; each R 4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
  • Table A Exemplary embodiments of the benzoxaborole compound are shown in Table A. Each compound in Table A can be represented by the formula (Ial). In some embodiments, the compound selected from Table A may be a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
  • a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb) is an embodiment where W is hydrogen and Y is hydrogen or a salt thereof.
  • a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb) is an embodiment where W is hydrogen and Y is fluorine or a salt thereof.
  • An exemplary embodiment of a benzoxaborole compound of formula lb is an embodiment wherein W is hydrogen and Y is chlorine or a salt thereof.
  • This embodiment has a chemical name (IUPAC name) of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol.
  • This exemplary compound may be referred to herein as BAG8:
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Id):
  • R a is selected from the group consisting of: methyl, ethyl, trimethylsilyl, isopropyl, and n-propyl,
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula
  • Y is a halogen and W is selected from the group consisting of: OMe, OEt, O-n-Propyl, 0-n-Butyl,OCHF 2 .
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (If):
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of: a Cl -Cl 5 hydrocarbyl, CH2PI1, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, n-pentyl, iso pentyl, and n-decyl; and
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
  • a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Ig):
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of: a Cl -Cl 5 hydrocarbyl, CH 2 Ph, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, n-pentyl, iso pentyl, and n-decyl;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
  • benzoxaborole compounds described herein may be present in a reversible equilibrium with water or other nucleophiles or other Lewis Bases due the Lewis acidic nature of the trigonal planar boron center (e.g. equilibrium between A and B below). This dynamic equilibrium may be important for the biological activity of various species of the benzoxaborole compounds described herein.
  • Exemplary species may include compounds of formula (A) and formula (B) below.
  • Benzoxaborole compounds may be present in free form, as a hydrate, as a salt, as a stereoisomer, as an enantiomer, or a tautomeric form; e.g., as an agronomically usable or an agrochemically acceptable salt form.
  • the benzoxaborole compounds and the formulations comprising benzoxaborole compounds described herein can be useful in providing a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen.
  • the pathogen may include insects, nematodes, bacteria, microbes, fungi, protozoa, viruses, parasites or any combinations thereof.
  • benzoxaborole compounds and the formulations comprising them can be used in methods for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen by applying an effective amount of the compound or formulation, wherein the pathogen is a fungi.
  • the disclosure includes a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by pests and/or a pathogen by applying a compound according to any one of the above formulae or a formulation of a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is a bacteria.
  • the disclosure includes a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by pests and/or a pathogen by applying a compound according to any one of the above formulae or a formulation of a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is an insect, nematode, bacteria, microbe, fungi, protozoa, virus, parasite or any combinations thereof.
  • Benzoxaborole compounds for example, a compound according to any one of the above formulae, can be used in a method for controlling or preventing an infestation of pests and/or a pathogen by treating a plant, plant part, plant propagation material, or seeds.
  • the pathogen may be a bacteria, microbe, fungi, or any combination thereof.
  • formulations of benzoxaborole compounds can be used in the same manner for controlling or preventing an infestation of pests and/or a pathogen by treating a plant, plant part, plant propagation material, or seeds.
  • bacterial pathogens may be classified as either gram-positive or gram-negative pathogens.
  • Antibiotic compounds with activity against both gram-positive and gram-negative pathogens are generally regarded as having a broad spectrum of activity.
  • the benzoxaborole compounds described herein are regarded as being active against gram-positive and/or gram negative bacterial pathogens.
  • Examples of gram-positive and gram-negative aerobic and anaerobic bacteria include Staphylococci, Enterococci, Streptococci, Bacilli, Listeria, Haemophilus, Moraxella,
  • Mycobacteria Staphylococci, Pseudomonas, Agrobacterium tumefaciens, and Escherichia.
  • Examples of fungi include: one or more members of the phyla of Ascomycota, Oomycota, Basidiomycota, and the subphylum Mucoromycotina.
  • the target fungi of the division Ascomycota include, for example, subdivision
  • Pezizomycotina and Taphrinomycotina which include Dothideomycetes, Leotiomycetes,
  • the target fungi of the phylum Ascomycota include , for example, subphylum selected from the group consisting of Dothideomycetes, Leotiomycetes, and Sordariomycetes.
  • the target fungi of the division Basidiomycota include, for example, subdivisions
  • the one or more target fungi whose growth is to be controlled or prevented is selected from one or more of the group consisting of Zymoseptoria, Phaeosphaeria, Erysiphe, Blumeria, Sclerotinia, Botrytis, Cercospora, Alternaria, Verticillium, Fusarium, Magnaporthe, Colletotrichum, Phakopsora, Puccinia, Rhizoctonia, Pythium,
  • Plasmopara Phytophthora, Aspergillus, Bipolaris, Candida, Cochliobolus, Dilophospora, Exserohilum, Mycosphaerella, Sclerophthora, Ustiligo, Melampsora, Oidiopsis, Phymatotrichum, Pyrenophora, Uncinula, Peronospora, Monolinia, Venturia, Phomopsis, Claviceps, Aspergillus, Dibotryon, Pseudoperonospora, Setosphaeria, and Podosphaera.
  • the one or more target fungi whose growth is to be controlled or prevented is selected from one or more of the group consisting of Zymoseptoria , Phaeosphaeria, Erysiphe, Blumeria, Sclerotinia, Botrytis, Cercospora, Alternaria, Verticillium, Fusarium, Magnaporthe, Colletotrichum, Phakopsora, Puccinia, Rhizoctonia, Pythium, Plasmopara, Phytophthora, Aspergillus, Bipolaris, Candida, Cochliobolus, Dilophospora, Exserohilum, Mycosphaeralla, Sclerophthora, Ustiligo, Melampsora, Oidiopsis,
  • the benzoxaborole compounds demonstrate antipathogenic activity, good plant tolerance, low toxicity to plants, while exhibiting minimal environmental impact.
  • benzoxaborole compounds and benzoxaborole formulations are suitable for protecting seeds, plants, plant organs, and plant propagation material, for increasing harvest yields, for improving the quality and/or vigor of the harvested material, in protection of stored products and of materials. They can be employed as plant protection agents. Moreover, the benzoxaborole compounds and benzoxaborole formulations are active against normally sensitive and resistant species and against all or some stages of development.
  • benzoxaborole formulations have several benefits and advantages.
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a
  • benzoxaborole a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
  • the carrier can be a solid or a liquid.
  • a method of using a benzoxaborole formulation comprises administering the formulation to seeds, plants, plant parts, and plant propagation materials in need thereof.
  • the formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound, a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier.
  • At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
  • the carrier can be a solid or a liquid.
  • a benzoxaborole formulation comprises the benzoxaborole compounds described herein; specifically, the benzoxaborole compounds represented by formulae (lb) and (Ic).
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ic):
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ic):
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb):
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • the boron can readily form a covalent bond with Lewis bases that may be present in the formulation.
  • the Lewis base may be, for example, a solvent, a surfactant, a carrier, or an adjuvant.
  • the boron of the benzoxaborole compound for example, the boron of the benzoxaborole of formula (Ic) may react with alcohol solvents (R 5 OH) present in the formulation to produce a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct (a Lewis adduct).
  • R 5 OH alcohol solvents
  • An example reaction to form a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct is shown in Scheme 2.
  • Exemplary alcohol solvents include, but are not limited to: C1-C15 branched saturated or unsaturated alcohols, C1-C15 linear saturated or unsaturated alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof.
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a
  • the boron of the benzoxaborole compound for example, the boron of the benzoxaborole of formula (lb) may react with alcohol solvents (R 5 OH) present in the formulation to produce a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct (a Lewis adduct).
  • R 5 OH alcohol solvents
  • An example reaction to form a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct is shown in Scheme 2A.
  • Exemplary alcohol solvents include, but are not limited to: C1-C15 branched saturated or unsaturated alcohols, C1-C15 linear saturated or unsaturated alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof.
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a mixture of a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ic) and a benzoxaborole compound of formula (If).
  • the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a mixture of a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb) and a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ig).
  • Exemplary benzoxaborole-alcohol adducts include the reaction products of (lb) or
  • the benzoxaborole compound of the benzoxaborole formulation may exist as an equilibrium mixture of the benzoxaborole and the benzoxaborole- alcohol adduct.
  • the benzoxaborole compound of the benzoxaborole formulation may exist as an equilibrium mixture of neutral planar benzoxaborole and ionic tetrahedral benzoxaborole. Exemplary equilibria are shown in Scheme 3. These dynamic equilibrium may be important for the biological activity of the compounds of formula (lb) and formula (Ic).
  • the benzoxaborole formulation may also comprise a second anti-fungal compound.
  • the second anti-fungal compound may be selected from a group of compounds with a preselected biochemical mode of action (MOA) as described by a FRAC Target Site Code.
  • MOA biochemical mode of action
  • the FRAC Target site code is selected from the group consisting of: B, C, D, E, G, H, and M.
  • the second anti-fungal compound has a FRAC Target Site Code selected from one or more of a FRAC groups consisting of Bl, B3, C3, C4, C6, Dl, El, E2, E3, Gl, H5, M4, and M5.
  • the FRAC Target Site Code single number designations are 1, 22, 11, 21, 30, 9, 13, 12, 2, 3, 40, M4, and M5, respectively.
  • the second anti-fungal compound comprises one or more of a compound selected from the group consisting of: carbendazim, thiabendazole, thiophanate, thiophanate-methyl, diethofencarb, zoxamide, ethaboxam, pencycuron, flupicolide, flutolanil, fluopyram, fluxapyroxad, penthiopyrad, benodanil, mepronil, isofetamid, fenfuram, carboxin, oxycarboxin, thifluzamide, benzovindiflupyr, bixafen, furametpyr, isopyrazam, penflufen, sedaxane, boscalid, benomyl, fuberidazole, diflumetorim, tolfenpyrad, azoxystrobin, coumoxystrobin, enoxastrobin, flufenoxystrobin, picoxystrobin, pyraoxystro
  • dimeoxystrobin dimeoxystrobin, fenamistrobin, methominostrobin, orysastrobin, famoxadone, fluoxastrobin, fenamidone, pyribencarb, cyazofamid, amisulbrom, binapacryl, meptyldinocap, dinocap, fluazinam, fentin chloride, fentin acetate, fentin hydroxide, silthiofam, ametoctradin, cyprodinil, mepanipyrim, pyrimethanil, kasugamycin, quinoxyfen, proquinazid, fenpiclonil, fludioxonil, chlozolinate, dimethachlone, iprodione, procymidone, vinclozolin, triforine, pyrifenox, pyrisoxazole, fenarimol, nuarimol, imazalil,
  • imibenconazole ipconazole, metconazole, myclobutanil, penconazole, propiconazole,
  • simeconazole simeconazole, tebuconazole, tetraconazole, triadimefon, triadimenol, triticonazole,
  • prothioconazole aldimorph, dodemorph, fenpropimorph, tridemorph, fenpropidin, piperalin, spiroxamine, fenhexamid, fenpyrazamine, pyributicarb, naftifine, terbinafine, validamycin, polyoxin, dimethomorph, flumorph, pyrimorph, benthiavalicarb, iprovalicarb, valifenalate, mandipropamid, ferbam, macozeb, maneb, metiram, propineb, thiram, zineb, ziram, captan, captafol, folpet, dichlofluanid, tolylfluanid, and chlorothalonil.
  • the formulations described herein can be used to control many pathogens including fungi, bacteria, insects, and parasites for the benefit of seeds, plants, plant parts, and/or plant propagation material.
  • the formulation or applied formulation may be administered systemically, topically, in the soil, as a seed treatment, or foliarly.
  • the formulation or applied formulation may be applied in any desired manner, such as in the form of a seed coating, soil drench, and/or directly in-furrow and/or as a foliar spray and applied either pre-emergence, post-emergence or both.
  • the formulation can be applied to the seed, the plant or to harvested fruits and vegetables or to the soil, wherein the plant is growing or wherein it is desired to grow (i.e., the plant's locus of growth).
  • the formulation is applied post-harvest by dipping, fogging, drenching, or soil drenching.
  • benzoxaborole formulation according to the invention is carried out directly or by action on their surroundings, habitat or storage space using customary treatment methods, for example dipping, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), drip irrigating.
  • customary treatment methods for example dipping, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), drip irrigating.
  • the formulation or applied formulation is applied foliarly.
  • the formulations may be selected from the following types of formulations: emulsifiable concentrates, coatable pastes, dilute emulsions, wettable powders, soluble powders, dusts, granulates, concentrated aqueous emulsions, suspension concentrates, oil dispersions, water dispersible granules, seed treatments, and also encapsulations/microencapsulations e.g. in substances.
  • the formulations described herein may be directly sprayable.
  • the formulations can also be further diluted to produce an applied formulation prior to being applied on plants or plant propagation materials. In some instances, the formulation is mixed with water to obtain the applied formulation.
  • a contemplated formulation can also contain further components such as stabilizers, antifoams, viscosity regulators, binders or tackifiers as well as fertilizers, micronutrient donors, or other formulations or active ingredients for obtaining special effects.
  • Suitable diluent media and adjuvants (auxiliaries) for the formulation can be solid or liquid and are substances useful in formulation technology, e.g., natural or regenerated mineral substances, carriers, solvents, dispersants, wetting agents, tackifiers, thickeners, binders, or fertilizers.
  • diluent media are for example described in WO 97/33890, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
  • water-based (more than 50 weight percent water) diluent media are presently preferred and are used illustratively herein.
  • the applied formulation can be employed in any conventional form, for example in the form of a powder, an emulsion, a microemulsion, a flowable
  • the benzoxaborole formulations can be produced by one of skill in the art of boron-chemistry, e.g., by mixing the active ingredients with appropriate formulation inerts such as solid or liquid carriers and optional other formulating ingredients such as surface-active compounds (surfactants), biocides, anti-freeze agents, stickers, thickeners and compounds that provide adjuvancy effects, and the like. Also, conventional slow release formulations can be employed where long-lasting efficacy is intended.
  • applied formulations may be applied in spraying forms, such as water dispersible concentrates, wettable powders, emulsifiable concentrates, suspension concentration and granules, can contain surfactants such as wetting and dispersing agents and other compounds that provide adjuvancy effects.
  • Carriers may be solid or liquid, and may comprise a Lewis base, or a N-H or O-H bond.
  • Solid, particulate carriers that can be used, for example for dusts and dispersible powders, are kaolinite, lactose, calcite, talc, kaolin, diatomaceous earth, montmorillonite or attapulgite, highly-disperse silica, or absorptive polymers.
  • Illustrative particulate, adsorptive carriers for granules include kaolinite, lactose, pumice, crushed brick, sepiolite or bentonite, montmorillonite-type clay, and exemplary nonsorbent carrier materials are calcite or dolomite.
  • a particulate solid formulation can also be prepared by encapsulation of a suitable mixture of fungicides, pesticides, or insecticides or by a granulation process that utilizes one or more of the above diluents or an organic diluent such as microcrystalline cellulose, rice hulls, wheat middlings, saw dust and the like.
  • Illustrative granules can be prepared as discussed in US Patents No. 4,936,901, No. 3,708,573 and No. 4,672,065.
  • Suitable liquid carriers include: protic solvents, aprotic solvents, water, substituted aromatic hydrocarbons, in particular the fractions C 8 -C 12 , such as xylene mixtures or substituted naphthalenes, phthalic esters such as dibutyl or dioctyl phthalate, substituted aliphatic hydrocarbons such as limonene, alcohols and glycols as well as their ethers and esters such as ethylene glycol monomethyl ether, C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof, keto
  • the liquid carrier can be a naturally occurring essential oil, such as oils from citronella, castor, lemon, citrus fruits, and lemon grass.
  • the liquid carrier comprises a Lewis Base such as a protic solvent.
  • the liquid carrier comprises a Lewis Base such as an alcohol.
  • the liquid carrier is a mixture comprising more than one suitable liquid carrier.
  • the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent or at least one alcohol selected from the group consisting of: C1-C15 branched alcohols (saturated or unsaturated), C1-C15 linear alcohols (saturated or unsaturated), benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, 1- hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof.
  • the liquid carrier comprises at least one protic solvent and at least one aprotic solvent.
  • the aprotic solvent is polar.
  • the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent, a polar aprotic solvent, and a non-polar aprotic solvent.
  • a polar aprotic solvent as defined herein, has a relatively large dielectric constant and a relatively large dipole moment, but it does not participate in hydrogen bonding (i.e., no O- H or N-H bonds).
  • exemplary polar aprotic solvents include acetone, N,N-dimethylformamide (DMF), acetonitrile (MeCN), and dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), N-methyl-2-pyrrolidone (NMP), cyclohexanone, and isophorone.
  • a non-polar aprotic solvent as defined herein, has a relatively small dielectric constant and a relatively small dipole moment.
  • exemplary non-polar aprotic solvents include aliphatic hydrocarbons, aromatic hydrocarbons, substituted aromatic hydrocarbons, xylene mixtures, substituted naphthalenes, substituted aliphatic hydrocarbons, limonene (single enantiomer or mixtures thereof), or a mixture thereof.
  • protic solvents are solvents that have a hydrogen atom bonded to an oxygen (i.e. comprises an O-H bond) or a nitrogen (i.e. comprises an N-H bond).
  • Exemplary protic solvent include: C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol (decyl alcohol), 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof.
  • Suitable surface-active compounds comprise non-ionic or ionic surfactants (cationic and/or anionic), may be a Lewis Base, may comprise an N-H bond, may comprise on O-H bond, and have good emulsifying, dispersing and wetting properties, depending mostly on the nature of the active ingredients.
  • surfactants is also to be understood as meaning mixtures of at least one surfactant.
  • At least one surfactant is often present when inert vehicles and/or carriers are not readily soluble in water.
  • the surfactant is at least one of a(n): amine ethoxylates, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (for example polysorbate 20), sorbitan fatty acid esters such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan
  • preferred non-ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, fatty alcohol ethoxylates, alkyl phenol ethoxylates, castor oil based ethoxylates (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (for example polysorbate 20), sorbitan fatty acid esters such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan
  • preferred ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulfphonates, alkyl ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether sulphates, condensed naphthalene sulfonates and salts, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blends, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, sodium alkylnaphthalene sulfonate, sodium alkylnapthalene formaldehyde condensates, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acids, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic salts, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic blends, fatty alcohol sulphates, alkyl ether carboxylic acids, alkyl ether carboxylic salts, alkyl ether sulphates, monosulphosucc
  • preferred non-ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to castor oil based ethoxylates (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), fatty acid ester ethoxylates such as Tween 21, Tween 20, Tween 85, Tween 60, and Tween 22, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (such as Tween 20, Tween 21, Tween 22), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates (such as Tween 20, Tween 21), polyoxyethylene sorbitan monostearates (such as Tween 60), polyoxyethylene sorbitan trioleates (such as Tween 85), and sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates (such as Tween 85), high molecular weight polymeric emulsifiers such as the star polymer ATLOX 4916, and sorbitan monolaurate.
  • Exemplary preferred non-ionic surfactants include, for example, Tween 21, Tween 22, T
  • Preferred ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, for example ATLOX 4838B.
  • particularly useful adjuvants which enhance application, are natural or synthetic phospholipids from the series of the cephalins and lecithins, for example phosphatidylethanolamine, phosphatidylserine, phosphatidylglycerine, or lysolecithin.
  • a contemplated formulation can also include at least one polymer that is a water-soluble or a water-dispersible, film-forming polymer that improves the adherence of the benzoxaborole compound to the treated material (e.g., seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation materials).
  • the polymer is a styrene acrylic emulsion polymer.
  • antioxidants include, but are not limited to: glycine, glycinebetaine, choline salts, in particular choline chloride, 2(3)-tert-butyl-4-hydroxyanisole (BHA), tert-butylhydroxyquinone (TBHQ), dilauryl thiodipropionate (DLTDP), tris(nonylphenyl))phosphite (TNPP), 2,6-dihydroxybenzoic acid (DHBA), acetylsalicylic acid (ASA), salicylic acid (SA), Irganox 1076 (Ciba Geigy), Ethanox 330 (Ethyl Corp.), Tinuvin 144 (Ciba Geigy), Ambiol (2-methyl-4- [dimethylaminomethyl]-5-hydroxybenzimidazole), propyl gallate, trihydroxybutyrophenone (THBP), thiodiprop
  • hindered phenol antioxidants are preferred.
  • hindered phenol antioxidants include: 2,6-di-tert-butyl-p-cresol (BHT) (CAS RN 128-37-0), 2(3)-tert-butyl-4-hydroxyanisole (BHA), isobutylenated methylstyrenated phenol (CAS RN 68457-74-9), styrenated phenol (CAS RN 61788-44-1), 2,6-di-tert-butyl-4- (octadecanoxycarbonylethyl)phenol (CAS RN 2082-79-3), 4,4'-thiobis-6-(t-butyl-m-cresol) (CAS RN 96-69-5), 4,4'-butylidenebis(6-t-butyl-m-cresol) (CAS RN 85-60-9), 4,4'-(l- methylethylidene)bis[2-(l,l-di
  • BHT 2,6-d
  • a coloring agent such as a dye or pigment
  • An antifungal formulation that includes a coloring agent is a preferred embodiment of the invention as it can improve user and consumer safety.
  • the coloring agent is also useful to indicate to the user the degree of uniformity of application. Generally, the coloring agent tends to have a melting point above 30 C, and therefore, is suspended in a contemplated formulation.
  • the coloring agent can also be a soluble compound.
  • coloring agents examples include pigment red 48-2 (CAS-7023-61-2), pigment blue 15 (CAS-147-14-8), pigment green 7 (CAS-1328-53-6), pigment violet 23 (CAS- 6358-30-1), pigment red 53-1 (CAS-5160-02-1), pigment red 57-1 (CAS 5281-04-9), pigment red 112 (CAS 6535-46-2) or similar coloring agents.
  • a coloring agent is typically present at about 0.1 to about 10% by mass of the formulation.
  • the benzoxaborole formulation composition is preferably formulated as a concentrate also known as a pre-mix composition (or concentrate, formulated compound, or formulation), and the end user normally employs a diluted formulation or an applied formulation for administration to the plants, plant propagation material, seeds, or plant parts of interest.
  • a diluted formulation is often referred to as a tank-mix composition or an applied formulation.
  • a tank-mix composition or applied formulation is generally prepared by diluting a pre-mix or formulation comprising a benzoxaborole compound with a diluent such as water that can optionally also contain further auxiliaries. Generally, an aqueous tank-mix is preferred.
  • a benzoxaborole formulation in particular an emulsion concentrate, includes about 0.01 to about 90% by weight benzoxaborole, about 0 to about 20% agriculturally acceptable surfactant and 1 to 99.99% solid or liquid carriers and adjuvant(s).
  • the formulation may include about 0.01 to 60 wt%, about 1.0 to 60 wt%, about 1.0 to 50 wt%, about 1.0 to 30 wt%, about 1.0 to 10 wt%, about 5.0 to 60 wt%, about 10 to 60 wt%, about 20 to 60 wt%, about 5 to 20 wt%, or about 20 to 40 wt% benzoxaborole.
  • the formulation may include up to about 20%, up to about 15%, up to about 10%, or up to about 5% surfactant.
  • the formulation may include about 1 to 99%, about 40 to 99%, about 50 to 99%, about 60 to 95%, about 70 to 95%, or about 80 to 99% solid or liquid carriers and agriculturally acceptable surfactant.
  • the formulation components enhance the biological or pesticidal activity of the benzoxaborole compound.
  • the formulation components may enhance the biological activity of the benzoxaborole compound.
  • some formulation components aid in formulation stability.
  • some formulation components aid in applied formulation stability.
  • a protic solvent is a Lewis Base, for example, an alcohol.
  • a protic solvent is also a solvent that has a hydrogen atom bound to an oxygen or a nitrogen.
  • a preferred embodiment of the formulation includes a liquid carrier comprising at least one protic solvent and at least one aprotic solvent.
  • having a suitable mixture of protic and aprotic solvent can be helpful in achieving an emulsion with a desirable D90 particle size.
  • the ratio of protic solvent to aprotic solvent can vary.
  • the ratio of protic solvent to aprotic solvent can be from about 20 to about 0.1.
  • the ratio can be from about 15 to about 0.25, from about 7 to about 0.25, from about 3 to about 0.25, or from about 1 to about 0.25.
  • the ratio of protic to aprotic solvent can be about 0.25, about 0.33, about 0.5, about 1, about 3, about 7, or about 15.
  • the ratio of protic to aprotic solvent is from about 1 to about 0.25, in particular, from about 1 to about 0.33.
  • the desirable D90 particle size varies and is dependent on the formulation type.
  • a desired particle size for an emulsion that is derived from an emulsion concentrate that has been diluted into water is less than about lOpm, less than about 5pm, less than about lpm, or between about 0.1 pm and 1.0 pm.
  • the formulation components aid in solubility.
  • the formulation components enhance the shelf life or shelf stability of the formulation.
  • the biological activity of the benzoxaborole formulation is higher than the biological activity of the same benzoxaborole compound alone.
  • a BAG8 compound may be more biologically active in a formulation than it is alone. While not being bound by theory, it is possible that the formulation components increase the biological activity of the benzoxaborole compound.
  • Suitable penetrants that may be used in the present context include all those substances which are typically used in order to enhance the penetration of active agrochemical compounds into plants.
  • Penetrants in this context are defined in that, from the (generally aqueous) application liquor and/or from the spray coating, they are able to penetrate the cuticle of the plant and thereby increase the mobility of the active compounds in the cuticle. This property can be determined using the method described in the literature (Baur et al., 1997, Pesticide Science 51, 131-152).
  • Examples include alcohol alkoxylates such as coconut fatty ethoxylate, or isotridecyl ethoxylate, fatty acid esters such as rapeseed or soybean oil methyl esters, fatty amine alkoxylates such as tallowamine ethoxylate, or ammonium and/or
  • phosphonium salts such as ammonium sulphate or diammonium hydrogen phosphate, for example.
  • the benzoxaborole content of the application forms prepared from the formulations after dilution may vary within wide ranges.
  • the active compound concentration of the application forms may be situated typically between 0.00000001% and 95% by weight of active compound, between about 0.001% and 1% by weight, or preferably between about 0.01% and 0.30% by weight based on the weight of the application form.
  • Application takes place in a customary manner adapted to the application forms.
  • the formulation as described above is used for reducing overall damage of seeds, plants, plant parts and plant propagation material, as well as losses in harvested fruits or vegetables caused by bacteria, fungi, insects, mites, nematodes, viruses, and/or phytopathogens.
  • the formulations as described above increases the overall plant health.
  • plant health generally comprises various sorts of improvements of plants that are not connected to the control of pests.
  • advantageous properties are improved crop characteristics including: emergence, crop yields, protein content, oil content, starch content, more developed root system, improved root growth, improved root size maintenance, improved root effectiveness, improved stress tolerance (e.g.
  • tillering increase, increase in plant height, bigger leaf blade, less dead basal leaves, stronger tillers, greener leaf color, pigment content, photosynthetic activity, less input needed (such as fertilizers or water), less seeds needed, more productive tillers, earlier flowering, early grain maturity, less plant verse (lodging), increased shoot growth, enhanced plant vigor, increased plant stand, and early and better germination.
  • Improved plant health preferably refers to improved plant characteristics including: crop yield, more developed root system (improved root growth), improved root size maintenance, improved root effectiveness, tillering increase, increase in plant height, bigger leaf blade, less dead basal leaves, stronger tillers, greener leaf color, photosynthetic activity, more productive tillers, enhanced plant vigor, and increased plant stand.
  • the formulations according to the present invention may be applied in any desired manner, such as in the form of a seed coating, soil drench, and/or directly in-furrow and/or as a foliar spray and applied either pre-emergence, post emergence or both.
  • the formulations can be applied to the seed, the plant, plant parts, plant propagation material, or to harvested fruits and vegetables or to the soil wherein the plant is growing or wherein it is desired to grow (plant's locus of growth).
  • the formulations according to the present invention are used for treating conventional or transgenic plants or seeds thereof.
  • the treatment of plants or plant parts (which includes seeds and plants emerging from the seed), harvested fruits and vegetables, with the formulations according to the invention are carried out directly or by action on their surroundings, habitat or storage space using customary treatment methods, for example dipping, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), drip irrigating.
  • customary treatment methods for example dipping, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), drip irrigating.
  • plant to be treated encompasses every part of a plant including its root system and the material—e.g., soil or nutrition medium— which is in a radius of at least 10 cm, 20 cm, 30 cm around the caulis or bole of a plant to be treated or which is at least 10 cm, 20 cm, 30 cm around the root system of said plant to be treated, respectively.
  • material e.g., soil or nutrition medium
  • the application rate of the formulations to be employed or used according to the present invention may vary. The skilled person is able to find the appropriate application rate by way of routine experiments.
  • methods for treating seed ought also to take into consideration the intrinsic insecticidal and/or nematicidal properties of pest-resistant or pest-tolerant transgenic plants, in order to achieve optimum protection of the seed and of the germinating plant with a minimal use of crop protection compositions.
  • the invention likewise relates to the use of the formulation of the invention for treating seed for the purpose of protecting the seed and the resultant plant against insects, mites, nematodes and/or phytopathogens.
  • the invention relates to seed which, following treatment with the formulation of the invention, is subjected to a film-coating process in order to prevent dust abrasion of the seed.
  • One of the advantages of the present invention is that, owing to the particular systemic properties of the formulations of the invention, the treatment of the seed with these formulations provides protection from insects, mites, nematodes and/or phytopathogens not only to the seed itself but also to the plants originating from the seed, after they have emerged. In this way, it may not be necessary to treat the crop directly at the time of sowing or shortly thereafter.
  • a further advantage is to be seen in the fact that, through the treatment of the seed with formulation of the invention, germination and emergence of the treated seed may be promoted.
  • formulation of the invention may also be used, in particular, on transgenic seed.
  • the invention further relates to seed treatment formulations that comprise a benzoxaborole, and optionally one or more additional fungicides, nematicides, or mixtures thereof.
  • Exemplary additional fungicides include: carbendazim, thiabendazole, thiophanate, thiophanate-methyl, diethofencarb, zoxamide, ethaboxam, pencycuron, flupicolide, flutolanil, fluopyram, fluxapyroxad, penthiopyrad, benodanil, mepronil, isofetamid, fenfuram, carboxin, oxycarboxin, thifluzamide, benzovindiflupyr, bixafen, furametpyr, isopyrazam, penflufen, sedaxane, boscalid, benomyl, fuberidazole, diflumetorim, tolfenpyrad, azoxystrobin, coumoxystrobin, enoxastrobin, flufenoxystrobin, picoxystrobin, pyraoxystrobin, mandestrobin, pyraclostrobin, pyrametostro
  • dimeoxystrobin dimeoxystrobin, fenamistrobin, methominostrobin, orysastrobin, famoxadone, fluoxastrobin, fenamidone, pyribencarb, cyazofamid, amisulbrom, binapacryl, meptyldinocap, dinocap, fluazinam, fentin chloride, fentin acetate, fentin hydroxide, silthiofam, ametoctradin, cyprodinil, mepanipyrim, pyrimethanil, kasugamycin, quinoxyfen, proquinazid, fenpiclonil, fludioxonil, chlozolinate, dimethachlone, iprodione, procymidone, vinclozolin, triforine, pyrifenox, pyrisoxazole, fenarimol, nuarimol, imazalil,
  • imibenconazole imibenconazole, ipconazole, metconazole, myclobutanil, penconazole, propiconazole, simeconazole, tebuconazole, tetraconazole, triadimefon, triadimenol, triticonazole,
  • prothioconazole aldimorph, dodemorph, fenpropimorph, tridemorph, fenpropidin, piperalin, spiroxamine, fenhexamid, fenpyrazamine, pyributicarb, naftifine, terbinafine, validamycin, polyoxin, dimethomorph, flumorph, pyrimorph, benthiavalicarb, iprovalicarb, valifenalate, mandipropamid, ferbam, macozeb, maneb, metiram, propineb, thiram, zineb, ziram, captan, captafol, folpet, dichlofluanid, tolylfluanid, and chlorothalonil.
  • Exemplary nematicides include: of avermectin nematicides, such as abamectin; carbamate nematicides, such as, aldicarb, thiadicarb, carbofuran, carbosulfan, oxamyl, aldoxycarb, ethoprop, methomyl, benomyl, alanycarb; and organophosphorus nematicides, such as, fenamiphos, fensulfothion, terbufos, fosthiazate, dimethoate, phosphocarb, dichlofenthion, isamidofos, fosthietan, isazofos ethoprophos, cadusafos, terbufos, chlorpyrifos, dichlofenthion, heterophos, isamidofos, mecarphon, phorate, thionazin, triazophos, diamidavermec
  • agents of the phosphate technology as a result of which, for example, colonization with symbionts is improved, such as rhizobia, mycorrhiza and/or endophytic bacteria, for example, is enhanced, and/or nitrogen fixation is optimized.
  • the formulations of the invention are suitable for protecting seed of any variety of plant which is used in agriculture, in greenhouses, in forestry or in horticulture. More particularly, the seed in question is that of cereals (e.g., wheat, barley, rye, oats and millet), maize, cotton, soybeans, rice, potatoes, sunflower, coffee, tobacco, canola, oilseed rape, beets (e.g., sugar beet and fodder beet), peanuts, vegetables (e.g., tomato, cucumber, bean, brassicas, onions and lettuce), fruit plants, lawns and ornamentals. Particularly important is the treatment of the seed of cereals (e.g., wheat, barley, rye and oats) maize, soybeans, cotton, canola, oilseed rape and rice.
  • cereals e.g., wheat, barley, rye, oats and millet
  • maize cotton
  • soybeans rice
  • potatoes sunflower
  • coffee tobacco
  • transgenic seed As already mentioned above, the treatment of transgenic seed with the formulation of the invention is particularly important.
  • the seed in question here is that of plants which generally contain at least one heterologous gene that controls the expression of a polypeptide having, in particular, insecticidal and/or nematicidal properties.
  • heterologous genes in transgenic seed may come from microorganisms such as Bacillus, Rhizobium,
  • the present invention is particularly suitable for the treatment of transgenic seed which contains at least one heterologous gene from Bacillus sp.
  • the heterologous gene in question comes from Bacillus thuringiensis .
  • the formulations of the invention are applied alone or in a suitable formulation to the seed.
  • the seed is preferably treated in a condition in which its stability is such that no damage occurs in the course of the treatment.
  • the seed may be treated at any point in time between harvesting and sowing.
  • seed is used which has been separated from the plant and has had cobs, hulls, stems, husks, hair or pulp removed.
  • seed may be used that has been harvested, cleaned and dried to a moisture content of less than 15% by weight.
  • seed can also be used that after drying has been treated with water, for example, and then dried again.
  • the amount of the formulation of the invention, and/or of other additives, that is applied to the seed is selected such that the germination of the seed is not adversely affected, and/or that the plant which emerges from the seed is not damaged. This is the case in particular with active ingredients which may exhibit phytotoxic effects at certain application rates.
  • the formulations of the invention can be applied directly, in other words without comprising further components, and without having been diluted. As a general rule, it is preferable to apply the formulations in the form of a suitable formulation to the seed.
  • formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention may be converted into the customary seed-dressing formulations, such as solutions, emulsions, suspensions, powders, foams, slurries or other coating compositions for seed, and also ULV formulations.
  • formulations are prepared by mixing the benzoxaborole and surfactant with customary adjuvants, such as, for example, customary extenders and also solvents or diluents, colorants, wetters, dispersants, emulsifiers, antifoams, antioxidants, preservatives, secondary thickeners, antifreezes, stickers, gibberellins, and also water.
  • customary adjuvants such as, for example, customary extenders and also solvents or diluents, colorants, wetters, dispersants, emulsifiers, antifoams, antioxidants, preservatives, secondary thickeners, antifreezes, stickers, gibberellins, and also water.
  • Colorants which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all colorants which are customary for such purposes. In this context, it is possible to use not only pigments, which are of low solubility in water, but also water-soluble dyes. Examples include the colorants known under the designations Rhodamin B, C.I. Pigment Red 112 and C.I. Solvent Red 1.
  • Wetters which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations and can be used in accordance with the invention, include all of the substances which promote wetting and which are customary in the formulation of active agrochemical ingredients. Use may be made preferably of alkylnaphthalenesulphonates, such as diisopropyl- or diisobutyl- naphthalenesulphonates .
  • Dispersants and/or emulsifiers which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations that can be used in accordance with the invention include all of the nonionic, anionic, and cationic dispersants that are customary in the formulation of active agrochemical ingredients. Use may be made preferably of nonionic or anionic dispersants or of mixtures of nonionic or anionic dispersants. Suitable nonionic dispersants are, in particular, ethylene oxide- propylene oxide block polymers, alkylphenol polyglycol ethers, polyalkylene oxide block co polymers, acrylic co-polymers and also tristryrylphenol polyglycol ethers, and the phosphate or sulphated derivatives of these.
  • Suitable anionic dispersants are, in particular, lignosulphonates, salts of polyacrylic acid, and arylsulphonate-formaldehyde condensates.
  • Antifoams which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all of the foam inhibitors that are customary in the formulation of active agrochemical ingredients. Use may be made preferably of silicone antifoams and magnesium stearate.
  • Antioxidants which may be present in the seed- dressing formulation are preferably those that have a low level of phy to toxicity. It is also preferred that the antioxidant that is used in the present method and formulations be one that is approved for use in food, feed, or cosmetics. Examples of such approval are approval by a regulatory body, such as the U.S. Food and Drug Administration for use in food or cosmetics, or approval by the U.S. Department of Agriculture for use. Antioxidants that have GRAS (Generally Recognized As Safe) status are examples of preferred antioxidants. In some embodiments of the present invention, it is preferred that the antioxidant is one that is added to the seed, as opposed to an antioxidant that is a natural component of the seed. However, such preferred antioxidants can include natural antioxidants that are added to the seed during the present treatment process.
  • Examples of materials that can serve as the antioxidant of the present invention include: glycine, glycinebetaine, choline salts, in particular choline chloride, 2(3)-tert-butyl-4- hydroxyanisole (BHA), tert-butylhydroxyquinone (TBHQ), dilauryl thiodipropionate (DLTDP), tris(nonylphenyl))phosphite (TNPP), 2,6-dihydroxybenzoic acid (DHBA), acetylsalicylic acid (ASA), salicylic acid (SA), Irganox 1076 (Ciba Geigy), Ethanox 330 (Ethyl Corp.), Tinuvin 144 (Ciba Geigy), Ambiol (2-methyl-4-[dimethylaminomethyl]-5-hydroxybenzimidazole), propyl gallate, trihydroxybutyrophenone (THBP), thiodipropionic acid and dilauryl
  • hindered phenol antioxidants are preferred.
  • hindered phenol antioxidants include: 2,6-di-tert-butyl-p-cresol (BHT) (CAS RN 128-37-0), 2(3)-tert-butyl-4-hydroxyanisole (BHA), isobutylenated methylstyrenated phenol (CAS RN 68457-74-9), styrenated phenol (CAS RN 61788-44-1), 2,6-di-tert-butyl-4- (octadecanoxycarbonylethyl)phenol (CAS RN 2082-79-3), 4,4'-thiobis-6-(t-butyl-m-cresol)
  • Preservatives which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all of the substances which can be employed for such purposes in agrochemical compositions. Examples include dichlorophen and benzyl alcohol hemiformal.
  • Secondary thickeners which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all substances which can be used for such purposes in agrochemical compositions. Those contemplated with preference include cellulose derivatives, acrylic acid derivatives, xanthan, modified clays and highly disperse silica.
  • Stickers which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all customary binders which can be used in seed dressing products. Preferred mention may be made of polyvinylpyrrolidone, polyvinyl acetate, polyvinyl alcohol, styrene acrylic emulsion polymers, polyethylene wax, and tylose.
  • the gibberellins are known (cf. R. Wegler,“Chemie der convinced fürschutz-und Schadlingsbekampfungsstoff”, Volume 2, Springer Verlag, 1970, pp. 401-412).
  • the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention may be used, either directly or after prior dilution with water, to treat seed of any of a wide variety of types. Accordingly, the concentrates or the preparations obtainable from them by dilution with water may be employed to dress the seed of cereals, such as wheat, barley, rye, oats and triticale, and also the seed of maize, rice, oilseed rape, peas, beans, cotton, sunflowers and beets, or else the seed of any of a very wide variety of vegetables.
  • the seed-dressing may be used, either directly or after prior dilution with water, to treat seed of any of a wide variety of types. Accordingly, the concentrates or the preparations obtainable from them by dilution with water may be employed to dress the seed of cereals, such as wheat, barley, rye, oats and triticale, and also the seed of maize, rice, oilseed rape, peas, beans
  • formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention, or their diluted preparations, may also be used to dress seed of transgenic plants. In that case, additional synergistic effects may occur in interaction with the substances formed through expression.
  • suitable mixing equipment includes all such equipment which can typically be employed for seed dressing. More particularly, the procedure when carrying out seed dressing is to place the seed in a mixer, to add the particular desired amount of seed-dressing formulations, either as such or following dilution with water beforehand, and to carry out mixing until the distribution of the formulation on the seed is uniform. This may be followed by a drying operation.
  • the application rate of the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention may be varied within a relatively wide range. It is guided by the particular amount of the at least one biological control agent and the at least one oxaborole in the formulations, and by the seed.
  • the application rates in the case of the composition are situated generally at between 0.001 and 50 g per kilogram of seed, preferably between 0.01 and 15 g per kilogram of seed.
  • the invention also relates to a method for controlling unwanted microorganisms, characterized in that the inventive composition is applied to the phytopathogenic fungi, phytopathogenic bacteria, and/or their habitat.
  • the formulations can be used to treat all plants, plant propagation material, and plant parts.
  • Plants means all plants and plant populations, such as desirable and undesirable wild plants, cultivars and plant varieties (whether or not protectable by plant variety or plant breeder's rights).
  • Cultivars and plant varieties can be plants obtained by conventional propagation and breeding methods which can be assisted or supplemented by one or more biotechnological methods such as by use of double haploids, protoplast fusion, random and directed mutagenesis, molecular or genetic markers or by bioengineering and genetic engineering methods.
  • plant parts are meant all above ground and below ground parts and organs of plants such as shoot, leaf, blossom and root, whereby for example leaves, needles, stems, branches, blossoms, fruiting bodies, fruits and seed as well as roots, corms and rhizomes are listed.
  • Crops and vegetative and generative propagating material for example cuttings, corms, rhizomes, runners and seeds also belong to plant parts.
  • inventive formulations when it is well tolerated by plants, have favorable toxicity and are well tolerated by the environment, are suitable for protecting plants and plant organs, enhances harvest yields and improves the quality of the harvested material. It can preferably be used as crop protection composition. It is active against normally sensitive and tolerant species and against all or some stages of development.
  • 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol may be referred to as“BAG8”.
  • the structure for 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol (BAG8) is:
  • Section I Exemplary Benzoxaborole Formulations
  • Example 1 Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by preparing a mixture containing
  • octylphenol polyethylene glycol ether Triton X-45, surfactant
  • 9.0 mg of sodium dodecylbenzenesulfonate 12 mg of polyethylene glycol 40 castor oil hydrogenated, 90 mg of cyclohexanone, 150 mg of xylenes, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol to obtain the emulsion concentrate.
  • the emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and during this time the initial white emulsion quickly formed a white precipitate and clear solution. Given the instability of the diluted (applied) formulation, the mixture was not subjected to particle size analysis.
  • Example 2 Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by first preparing a mixture containing 9.0 mg of octylphenol polyethylene glycol ether (Triton X-45), 18.0 mg of sodium dodecylbenzenesulfonate, 12 mg of polyethylene glycol 40 castor oil hydrogenated, 90 mg of cyclohexanone, 150 mg of xylenes, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol. The emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation).
  • the applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and during this time the initial white emulsion quickly formed a white precipitate and clear solution. When sieved, large chunks of material were trapped on each sieve, indicating a particle size greater than 297 pm.
  • Example 3 Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of benzyl alcohol, 0.2 g of isophorone, 0.2 g of xylenes, 80 mg of Tween 20, and 30 mg of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol.
  • This emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing).
  • the applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and then sieved successively through #50, #100, and #325 sieves to determine particle size.
  • the applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 20 minutes and passed through each sieve, indicating a stable formulation with a particle size of less than 44 mih.
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of isophorone, 0.4 g of xylenes, 80 mg of Tween 20, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and then sieved successively through #50, #100, and #325 sieves to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 20 minutes.
  • Example 5 Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of isophorone, 80 mg of Tween 20, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the emulsion showed a D 50 of 111 pm and a D 90 of 146 pm.
  • Example 6 Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 1.6 g of n-butanol, 0.8 g chlorobenzene, 0.32 g of Tween 20, 0.16 g of Span 20, 0.14 g of ATLOX 4838, and 0.12 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol.
  • This emulsion concentrate was then added to 80 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing).
  • the applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size.
  • the applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the emulsion showed a D50 of 1.31 pm and a D90 of 4.36 pm.
  • Example 7 Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of benzyl alcohol,
  • Example 8 Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 40 mg of xanthan gum, 20 mg of anti-microbial, 74.09 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol.
  • 150 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing).
  • the applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size.
  • the applied formulation remained a white suspension over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the solution showed a D50 of 10.70 pm and a D90 of 25.50 pm.
  • Example 9 Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Formulation Stability
  • a sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 40 mg of xanthan gum, 20 mg of anti-microbial, 74.09 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol.
  • the formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 10 days at; 5°C, 20°C, and 50°C, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size.
  • the 50°C sample demonstrated hard sedimentation and settling of active ingredient but there was little to no change at the other temperature conditions.
  • the applied formulation showed particle sizes illustrated by the table below.
  • Example 10 Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.24 g of xanthan gum, 0.12 g of anti-microbial, 73.79 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol.
  • 150 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing).
  • the applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size.
  • the applied formulation remained a white suspension over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the suspension showed a D 50 of 6.10 pm and a D 90 of 15.50 pm.
  • Example 11 Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Formulation Stability
  • a sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 40 mg of xanthan gum, 20 mg of anti-microbial, 73.79 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol.
  • the formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 10 days at; 5°C, 20°C, and 50°C, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. Visually, the sample displayed little to no change over the 10 days at the three temperature conditions. When analyzed, the diluted formulation showed particle sizes illustrated by Table 1 below.
  • Example 12 Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol.
  • 150 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing).
  • the applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size.
  • the applied formulation remained a white suspension over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the solution showed a D 50 of 4.57 pm and a D 90 of 16.1 pm.
  • Example 13 Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Formulation Stability
  • a sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol.
  • the formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 10 days at; 5°C, 20°C, and 50°C, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. Visually, the sample displayed little to no change over the 10 days at the three temperature conditions. When analyzed, the applied formulation showed particle sizes illustrated by Table 2 below.
  • Example 14 Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied
  • a sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. 23 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 90%, comparable to the control which had a germination rate of 98%. Table 3.
  • Example 15 Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied Germination
  • a sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. 46 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 95%, similar to the control, which had a germination rate of 98%.
  • Example 16 Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied Germination
  • a sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. 70 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 95%, which is similar to the germination rate of the control (98%).
  • Example 17 Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied Germination
  • a sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. 0.14 g of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 95% which was similar to the germination rate of the control (98%).
  • Example 18 Wettable Power Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample wettable powder was prepared by jet milling 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol (30%), Kaolin (60%), Morwet D-425 (8%), and Morwet EFW (2%) .
  • 0.50 g of the wettable powder formulation was added to 50 mL of water in a graduated cylinder and the resulting suspension was visually monitored over the course of 5 days. While the applied formulation slowly settled over the course of 24 hours, the particulate the bottom of the graduated cylinder easily resuspended upon mixing. When analyzed, the applied formulation showed a D50 of 2.93 pm and a D90 of 6.97 pm.
  • Example 19 Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
  • a sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of benzyl alcohol, 0.4 g isophorone, 0.4 g of xylenes, 0.16 g of polyethylene glycol 40 castor oil hydrogenated, 28 mg of ATLOX 4838, and 42 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol.
  • This emulsion concentrate was then added to 40 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing).
  • the applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size.
  • the applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the emulsion showed a D50 of 6.70 pm and a D90 of 15.4 pm.
  • BAG8 emulsion concentrates were prepared.
  • the formulations were prepared by mixing the components shown in Table 7. All components in the table are provided as % w/w (percent by weight-the percentage weight of each substance of the total EC weight).
  • Example 21 SC and EC Formulation Stability
  • BAG8 formulation samples were stored at 5°C, 20°C, or 50°C, and the stability of the samples was determined by visual appearance at time points of 0 days and 10 days.
  • the particle size was also determined for each sample following dilution into water at each time point using a particle size analyzer (Malvern 3000E). D 90 particle size values were recorded for each sample and each time point.
  • the pH of each sample was also recorded for each temperature at day zero and day 10.
  • the pH of the diluted/applied formulation it is desirable for the pH of the diluted/applied formulation to remain the same or to change minimally when the formulation is stored at various temperatures. It is also desirable for the D 90 of the diluted/applied formulation to remain the same or to change minimally when the formulation is stored at various temperatures. As can be seen below, the pH remained the same or similar for many exemplary formulations at day 0 and at day 14 (compared to the 20 °C sample at day zero). Generally, the pH of the applied/diluted formulation may influence whether the benzoxaborole (BAG8) is in its neutral, planar form, or its ionic, tetrahedral form.
  • BAG8 benzoxaborole
  • the amount of SC used for all tests was calculated such that there was 30 mg of BAG8 in each test.
  • the adjuvants were tank-mixed with BAG8 SC at the label rate, using the mixing instructions indicated on the label.
  • Each test used 20 mL of water.
  • Example 10 The BAG8 SC formulations described in Example 10 (BAG8 20% SC) and Example 12 (BAG8 40% SC) and selected BAG8 SC-tank mix formulations described in Example 23 were tested under greenhouse conditions. Data was obtained for soybean/white mold ( Sclerotinia sclerotiorum ), wheat/septoria ( Mycosphaerella graminicola), and watermelon/downy mildew. For each experiment, the BAG8 was applied at a rate of 0.25 lb/acre and at a spray rate of 20 gal/acre.
  • the BAG8 EC used was: 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX 4838B
  • Unformulated BAG8 was applied to the plants by dissolving BAG8 in a 30% acetone-70% water solution.
  • results show that, in many instances, the plants treated with unformulated BAG8 did not have lower disease severity than an untreated control. Thus, the results indicate that formulated BAG8 is more effective than unformulated BAG8. In fact, the level of efficacy for unformulated BAG8 falls below the industry standard for commercial formulation development. [00257] Contrastingly, the results show that plants treated with a BAG8 SC, BAG8 EC, or BAG8 WP are more healthy than untreated plants in all cases and in most instances the plants are also more healthy than those treated with unformulated BAG8.
  • BAG8 EC formulations used for this example are shown below Table 16.
  • the protocol described in Example 25 was used for this assay.
  • BAG8 EC 1 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX
  • BAG8 EC 2 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC 3 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC 1 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX
  • BAG8 EC 2 38.2% isophorone, 19.1% decyl alcohol, 19.1% xylenes, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% BAG8, 9.6% Tween 60
  • BAG8 EC 3 9.5% isophorone, 66.7% decyl alcohol, 4.4%
  • BAG8 EC 4 57.3% decyl alcohol, 19.1% isophorone, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC 6 4.8% isophorone, 71.7% decyl alcohol, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC 7 19.1% isophorone, 38.2% decyl alcohol, 19.1% limonene, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 85, 9.6% BAG8
  • BAG8 EC 8 19.1% isophorone, 38.2% decyl alcohol, 19.1% xylenes, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 60, 9.6% BAG8
  • BAG8 EC formulations used for this example are shown below Table 18.
  • the protocol described in Example 25 was used for this assay.
  • BAG8 EC 1 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX
  • BAG8 EC 2 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC 3 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC 4 57.3% decyl alcohol, 19.1% isophorone, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC formulations used for this example are shown below Table 19.
  • the protocol described in Example 25 was used for this assay.
  • BAG8 EC 1 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6%
  • BAG8 EC 2 38.2% isophorone, 19.1% decyl alcohol, 19.1%
  • BAG8 EC 3 9.6% isophorone, 66.9% decyl alcohol, 4.5%
  • BAG8 EC 4 57.3% decyl alcohol, 19.1% isophorone, 4.5%
  • FIG. 2 contains a table that provides chemical characterization data for a number of exemplary benzoxaborole compounds, including some of those for which synthesis is described in the examples below.
  • FIG. 2 contains chemical structure, formula, IUPAC chemical name, MS, and HPLC purity data for each compound.
  • reaction mixture was poured into saturated aqueous NH 4 Cl solution (20 mL) at 0°C, and stirred for 3 min.
  • the aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (15 mL x 3).
  • the combined organic phase was washed with brine (10 mL x 1), dried with anhydrous Na 2 S0 4 , filtered and concentrated in vacuum.
  • reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure, giving a residue that was purified by prep-HPLC (column: x-chargel50*25mm*5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 35%-53%, 10 min) to give 5,7-dichloro-N- (cyclopropylmethyl)-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (0.053 g, 194.90 umol, 76.33% yield, 100% purity) as a yellow solid.
  • the reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo, and water (300 mL) and EtOAc (100 mL) were added. The resulting mixture was stirred at 25°C for 30 min. The organic phase became brown, and the aqueous was green with insoluble materials. The whole mixture was filtered through Celite and washed with EtOAc (100 mL x 3). The organic layer was separated, washed with brine (100 mL x 3), dried over Na 2 S0 4 , filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to give a residue.
  • Section III Biological Materials and Methods Example 1. Fungal and oomycetal isolates
  • Botrytis cinerea B16 was obtained from the Plant Pathology and Environmental Microbiology Department at The
  • Mycosphaerella fijiensis Briefly, mycelial cultures of M. fijiensis isolates 11CR-33 grown on PDA medium were macerated in water, and 1-5 mL of the resulting suspension was pipetted onto plates of modified V8 medium (0.2g/L CaC0 3 , 100 mL/L V8 juice and 20g/L Difco agar). Cultures were incubated at 20°C under continuous, cool- white fluorescent and black light. After 5-7 days, sporulation plates were stimulated to produce conidia by adding 2 mL water and brushing the plates with a paint brush or cell spreader and removing the resulting suspension.
  • modified V8 medium 0.2g/L CaC0 3 , 100 mL/L V8 juice and 20g/L Difco agar.
  • conidia were harvested in the same way, adding 2 mL 0.05% Tween 20 solution, brushing the plates to dislodge spores, and removing the spore suspension by pipetting. Spores were diluted in half strength broth medium.
  • Rhizoctonia solani due to insufficient spore obtained from these fungi, inocula were prepared as mycelium visible fragments.
  • fungal mycelium grown on agar media were cut into lxlmm pieces and cultured in autoclaved broth medium (such as PDB and V8). After 3-7 days of incubation at 22-24°C, mycelia were harvested by filtering through one layer of Miracloth. The mycelia were homogenated in half strength of broth medium using household blender for 10 seconds and filtered through one layer Miracloth. The resultant visible fragments were diluted in half strength broth medium.
  • Fusarium oxysporum f. sp.
  • V8 agar the isolate of Fusarium oxysporum f. sp. cubense TR4 was maintained on V8 agar (20% - 200 mL V8 juice, 2 g CaC0 3 , 15 g Agar, 800 mL distilled water. Spore suspensions were prepared in half strength PDB broth medium with 0.1% Tween 20.
  • MICs minimal inhibitory concentrations
  • the individual MICs were determined in triplicate in a final volume of 0.2 mL/well with antifungal concentrations of 0.2 - 25 pg/mL (8 serial dilutions down from 25 pg/mL [25, 12.5, 6.25, 3.13, 1.56, 0.78, 0.39 and 0.20 pg/mL]; control studies with 0 pg/mL of compounds were performed in parallel for each plate). Plates sealed with clear polyester film (VWR) were incubated at a temperature of about 22°C. The progress of fungal growth was monitored at 72 hours.
  • VWR clear polyester film
  • the MICs were determined as the lowest antifungal concentrations that inhibited fungal growth by greater than 95% (determined as relative absorbance using the Bio-Tek® SynergyTM Hl microplate reader at 600 nm) relative to the corresponding antifungal-free control.
  • E coli Escherichia coli
  • Agrobacterium tumefaciens A. tumefaciens
  • the present invention relates to benzoxaborole formulations comprising a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, or the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
  • the carrier is a solid or a liquid.
  • a method of using benzoxaborole formulations for phytopathogenic compositions comprises administering the formulation to crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, plant propagation material, in need thereof.
  • the composition comprises a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier.
  • At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, or the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
  • the carrier is a solid or a liquid.
  • the carrier is a liquid, wherein the liquid carrier is a mixture comprising more than one suitable liquid carrier.
  • the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent or at least one alcohol selected from the group consisting of: C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1- propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof.
  • the liquid carrier comprises at least one protic solvent and at least one aprotic solvent.
  • Preferred non-ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, high molecular weight polymers, polycondensates of ethylene oxide with fatty alcohols or with fatty acids or with fatty amines, substituted phenols (in particular alkylphenols or arylphenols such as mono- and di-(polyoxyalkylene alkylphenol), polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphated tristyrylphenols and polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphoric esters of alcohols or phenols, amine ethoxylates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (for example polysorbate 20), sorbitan fatty acid esters such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene
  • Preferred ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, alkyl ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether sulphates, condensed naphthalene sulfonates and salts, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blends, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulfonate, sodium alkylnapthalene formaldehyde condensates, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acids, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic salts, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic blends, fatty alcohol sulphates, alkyl ether carboxylic acids, alkyl ether carboxylic salts, alkyl ether sulphates, monosulphosuccinates, polysulphosuccinates, alkyl phosphates, alkyl benzene sulphonic acids, alkyl
  • the applied formulation has a pH of 5-10. In other preferred embodiments of the present invention, the applied formulation has a pH of 5.5-8.
  • the formulation is 0.1— 60 % w/v (or w/w) benzoxaborole if the carrier is a liquid.
  • the formulation is 1-60% w/w (or w/w) benzoxaborole.
  • the formulation is 10 - 80 % w/v(or w/w) benzoxaborole if the carrier is a solid.
  • the formulation includes at least 0.01% w/w non-ionic surfactant or non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture and can include up to 20% w/w non-ionic surfactant or non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture.
  • the surfactant comprises at least one of a fatty alcohol ethoxylate, alkyl phenol ethoxylate, castor oil based ethoxylate, fatty acid ethoxylate, a polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate (for example polysorbate 20), a sorbitan fatty acid ester such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, a polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan monolaurate, EO- PO block co-polymer, acrylic co-polymer, styrene acrylic polymer, sorbitan(ol) ester ethoxylate, sarcosinate, alkyl polysaccharide, alkyl amine ethoxylate, amine oxide, siliconics, graft and/or comb polymer (ethoxylated or propoxylated and non ethoxylated), alkyl ether phosphate, alkyl ether phosphate, alkyl ether
  • the surfactant is at least one of a(n): amine ethoxylates, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil, sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, non-ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary alcohol ethoxylates, nonylphenol ethoxylates, or octylphenol ethoxylates.
  • a(n) amine ethoxylates, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil, sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, non-ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary
  • the formulation additionally includes an antioxidant.
  • the formulation can include combinations of active ingredients, biologies, extracts, adjuvants,
  • antioxidants or other additives.
  • An applied formulation may be obtained by diluting the formulation.
  • the formulation may be diluted into water to obtain the applied formulation.
  • An applied formulation can be produced by diluting the formulation, then spraying, atomizing, dusting, scattering, coating, or pouring.
  • the formulation can also be applied directly (i.e., without dilution) by spraying, atomizing, dusting, scattering, coating, or pouring.
  • Pathogens including fungi, bacteria, insects, parasites may be controlled using the formulations described herein for the benefit of plants.
  • the formulations or applied formulations may be applied or administered systemically, topically, in the soil, as a seed treatment, or foliarly.
  • a method of reducing growth of a target fungus/bacteria/insect/pest is contemplated.
  • a target fungus/bacteria/pest is contacted with an effective amount of the compounds described herein, and that contact is maintained for a period of time sufficient to control and/or inhibit growth of the target fungus/bacteria/pest.
  • contact is carried out by administering the compounds described herein.
  • the target fungus/bacteria/pest where the administration is topical, soil, seed treatment, foliar, or systemic.
  • the administration is topical, soil, seed treatment, foliar, or systemic.
  • the compounds described herein are used for reducing overall damage of plants and plant parts as well as losses in harvested fruits or vegetables caused by bacteria, fungi, and/or phytopathogens.
  • the compounds described herein increase the overall plant health.
  • the compounds described herein have potent microbicidal activity and can be used for control of unwanted pathogens and microorganisms, such as fungi and bacteria, in crop protection and in the protection of plant materials.
  • pathogen broadly includes causative agents of disease, such as, pathogenic bacterium, fungi, virus, or other
  • microorganism that can cause disease.
  • the described compound is a fungicide, it can be used in crop protection for control of phytopathogenic fungi.
  • the compound can include an outstanding efficacy against a broad spectrum of phytopathogenic fungi, including soil borne pathogens, which are in particular members of the classes Plasmodiophoromycetes, Peronosporomycetes (Syn. Oomycetes), Chytridiomycetes, Zygomycetes, Ascomycetes, Basidiomycetes, and Deuteromycetes (Syn. Fungi imperfecti).
  • Some fungicides are systemically active and can be used in plant protection as foliar, seed dressing or soil fungicide.
  • the compounds are suitable for combating fungi, which inter alia infest wood or roots of plant.
  • Improved plant health refers to improved plant characteristics including: crop yield, more developed root system (improved root growth), improved root size maintenance, improved root effectiveness, tillering increase, increase in plant height, bigger leaf blade, less dead basal leaves, stronger tillers, greener leaf color,
  • the invention includes a compound of formula (I):
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH 3 , CF 3 , Et, OCH , OCF , OCFiH, CFH 2 , OEt, O-n-propyl, O-n-butyl, O- iso-propyl, O-sec -butyl, O-iso-butyl, O-cyclopropyl, O-cyclbutyl, C(0)H, CN, CH2OH, SR 1 , and S(0)R 1 , wherein R 1 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, R 2 , OR 2 , OCF2H, NR 2 2, NHR 2 , NH 2 , halogen, CO2R 2 , CN, OH, CH 2 OH, N0 2 , C(0)H, SR 2 , and S(0)R 2 , wherein each R 2 is independently selected from C1-C7 hydrocarbyl and C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl or each R 2 can be taken together to form a ring;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH 3 , NO2,
  • R 3 is selected from C1-C4 hydrocarbyl and C3-C4 cyclohydrocarbyl;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, R 4 , NR 4 2, NHR 4 , NH 2 , NO2, CO2R 4 , OR 4 , OH, OCF 2 H, SR 4 , and S(0)R 4 , wherein R 4 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl and C3 cyclohydrocarbyl; and
  • V and V’ are independently selected from the group consisting of
  • the invention includes a method for reducing or preventing an infestation by a pathogen by applying an effective amount of a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is selected from the group consisting of bacteria, microbes, fungi, and any combinations thereof.
  • the invention includes a method for reducing or preventing an infestation by a pathogen by applying a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is selected from the group consisting of bacteria, microbes, fungi, and any combinations thereof.
  • the invention includes a method for controlling or preventing an infestation of the pathogen by treating an, plant, plant part, or plant propagation material with an effective amount of a compound according to a compound of the disclosure.
  • the invention includes a method for controlling or preventing an infestation of the pathogen by treating a plant, plant part, or plant propagation material with a compound according to the disclosure.
  • a benzoxaborole formulation composition comprising:
  • non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture
  • carrier wherein at least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond, and wherein the carrier is a solid or a liquid.
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • polysulphosuccinates alkyl phosphates, alkyl benzene sulphonic acids, alkyl benzene sulphonic salts, lignosulphonates and salts, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, and alpha olefin sulphonates
  • a second liquid selected from the group consisting of: aliphatic hydrocarbons, aromatic hydrocarbons, substituted aromatic hydrocarbons, xylene mixtures, substituted naphthalenes, substituted aliphatic hydrocarbons and limonene.
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
  • W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
  • L is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyl, halogen, and straight chain or branched alkyl glycol, or L may be taken together to form a ring, and
  • M is a metal
  • composition of enumerated embodiments 13, wherein L is hydroxide, n 1, and M is selected from the group consisting of K, Na, and Cu.
  • composition of enumerated embodiments 11, wherein L is hydroxide, n 2, and M is selected from the group consisting of Cu, Mg, Mn, Ca, and Zn.
  • composition of enumerated embodiments 11, wherein L is hydroxide, n 3, and M is selected from the group consisting of Cu, Mn, and Al.

Landscapes

  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Agronomy & Crop Science (AREA)
  • Pest Control & Pesticides (AREA)
  • Plant Pathology (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Dentistry (AREA)
  • Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
  • Environmental Sciences (AREA)
  • Toxicology (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Dispersion Chemistry (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Agricultural Chemicals And Associated Chemicals (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Catching Or Destruction (AREA)
  • Pretreatment Of Seeds And Plants (AREA)

Abstract

A benzoxaborole formulation composition including a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier is described herein. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond. The carrier is a solid or a liquid. Benzoxaborole compounds and methods of using the compounds and formulations of the compounds are described. For example, a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen by applying a compound or a formulation of a compound, wherein the pathogen is selected from insects, nematodes, bacteria, microbes, fungi, protozoa, viruses, and parasites, or any combinations thereof is described.

Description

BENZOXABOROLE COMPOUNDS AND FORMULATIONS THEREOF
CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
[001] This application claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Application No. 62/593,226, filed on November 30, 2017. This application also claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Application No. 62/743,489, filed on October 9, 2018.
TECHNICAL FIELD
[002] The present invention relates to benzoxaborole compounds and to formulations of benzoxaborole compounds comprising surfactants and/or suitable carriers for agricultural or therapeutic use (e.g., as phytopathogenic and/or infectious agent control, growth enhancement or control). The invention also relates to methods of using the benzoxaborole compounds and the formulations thereof.
BACKGROUND
[003] Boron is a unique, and often misconstrued, element of the periodic table due to its powerfully effective and potentially high toxicological properties. Initial innovation in the field of boron chemistry was impaired due to the incapacity to prepare pure boron, especially in its crystalline form. Early characterization of boron-containing molecules was also stymied by contamination of that crystalline form by aluminum. While the use of boron, in the form of boric acid, is well known for its use in agriculture, the construction and characterization of more complex boron-containing molecules that are both safe and effective has been relatively unexplored. Only recently has boron been explored by skilled organo -metallic chemists for novel and useful applications across human/animal health and agriculture. For example, boron- containing molecules such as oxaboroles and benzoxaboroles demonstrate use as antimicrobials, antiparasitics, and antifungals. (See Publication No. WO2016128949 (antimicrobial), U.S.
Patent No. 9,617,285 (antiparasitic), and Publication No. WO2016164589 (antifungal)).
[004] The creation and development of such boron-containing compounds has proven to be unpredictable. Even in the hands of experts, boron containing scaffolds present compounds that must be tested from a toxicology, mode of action, and activity perspective. Moreover, once the target compounds are made and tested, formulation of those compounds can be laborious due to issues such as pKa, pH, and solubility. The duplicitous nature of boron-containing compounds places their activity on a broad continuum; including those that are highly toxic, and those that are exceptionally benign. Thus, creation of novel and useful boron-containing compounds requires skilled attention to design, synthesis, formulation, as well as thoughtful screening to determine toxicity, mode of action, and efficacy.
[005] Moreover, boron’s ability to covalently bond with other molecules makes it both attractive and difficult to work with. Boron-containing products have traditionally suffered in becoming commercially viable products due to synthetic and pharmacological uncertainties. However, these characteristics can be leveraged, in the right hands, to make great impact in the areas of crop protection and animal health.
[006] In addition to being capable of affecting a diverse array of pathogens by themselves, previous literature demonstrates the unique ability of boron-chemistry to enhance the efficacy of known active ingredients. See U.S. Patent No. 9,737,075.
[007] Within the field of plant health, fungal, bacterial, insect, and nematode plant pathogens lead to a wide range of diseases (rusts, spots, downy mildews, blasts, blotches, stripes, rots, smuts, pathogenic nematodes, erwinia, insects, etc.) across all crops, resulting in massive losses. Current solutions are limited; providing only a partial level of control (as with resistant cultivars), or adding significant costs relative to currently available, conventional, and outdated chemical pesticides. While breeding for resistance traits to specific crop/pathogen combinations in germplasm offers some hope in circumventing the problem, it is widely recognized that novel antifungals must be developed.
[008] Antifungals, insecticides, and pesticides are costly to both purchase and use, as well as often being toxic and/or otherwise detrimental to off-target vegetation near the site of application including runoff, affecting the watershed. Moreover, many antifungals, insecticides, and pesticides lose efficacy over time, concomitantly with pathogens becoming resistant to treatment. It is beneficial to farmers, consumers, and their surrounding communities to use the minimum required dose of antifungals, insecticides, and/or pesticides to achieve maximum crop yield, while mitigating onset of resistance and environmental detriment.
[009] While some benzoxaboroles have been demonstrated to exhibit antibacterial and antifungal activities, they have not been successfully employed as a commercial product for crop protection and agricultural pest-control. One reason may be the fluxional and reactive nature of benzoxaboroles. Benzoxaboroles can exist in a neutral trigonal planar geometry, an ionic tetrahedral geometry, or a mixture of both of these geometries depending on the specific environment of the benzoxaborole. Specifically, solvents, surfactants, stabilizers, antioxidants, pH, and other adjuvants commonly used as formulation ingredients can easily alter the
benzoxaborole’ s geometry, formal charge (neutral trigonal or ionic tetrahedral) and
complexation species in unpredictable ways. Further, this difference in formal charge (neutral vs. ionic), geometry (trigonal vs. tetrahedral), and complexation can greatly affect the biological activity of the benzoxaborole. For example, each benzoxaborole geometry can bind to a target protein differently, and the charge (neutral vs. ionic) can influence the cell permeability.
Depending on the geometry and charge of the benzoxaborole, the benzoxaborole can ultimately be an effective, potent compound, or a compound that shows little or no bioactivity.
Furthermore, the neutral trigonal planar benzoxaborole and ionic tetrahedral benzoxaborole each have unique physical chemical properties that are important to consider to develop an efficacious formulation of the benzoxaborole (e.g. solubility, stability, and pH).
[0010] It is an object of the present disclosure to provide compounds exhibiting control (e.g., curative, inhibitive, ameliorative, and/or preventative activity) of phytopathogens, fungi, pathogenic bacteria and/or microorganisms, and the like.
[0011] Surprisingly, the compounds described herein, when applied to plants, seeds, plant parts, harvested fruits, vegetables and/or plant’s locus of growth allows for effective control of pathogenic microorganisms, fungi, bacteria, and other phytopathogens.
[0012] While the formulation of traditional, non-boron containing, organic active ingredients can be predicted by the physical characteristics of the overall molecule (logP, melting point, solubility, compound polarity, etc), the formulation of benzoxaboroles has an aspect of unpredictability - the formulation of the relatively reactive benzoxaborole functional group. In contrast to traditional, non-boron containing, organic active ingredients, the charge and geometry of the benzoxaborole is not static. Rather, the benzoxaborole can exist in a fluxional state, wherein the compound is in a dynamic equilibrium between the neutral, trigonal planar state and the ionic, trigonal planar state (Scheme 1). Additionally, substitutions on the benzoxaborole can have profound effects on this dynamic equilibrium. These characteristics together make the formulation of benzoxaborole compounds an unpredictable and challenging endeavor.
Figure imgf000006_0001
Scheme 1
[0013] Furthermore, benzoxaboroles are primarily organic (easier to dissolve in organic solvents than in more water-like solvents) in nature due to being composed of predominately
hydrocarbons. However, they also possess a relatively polar boron-hydroxyl group in the overall chemical structure, and the boron-hydroxyl group prefers to be in more water-like solvent.
Additionally, the boron atom has an empty p-orbital, which readily forms covalent bonds with Lewis bases that may be present in the formulation (potentially affecting biological activity). Thus, the empty p-orbital on the boron of the benzoxaborole makes formulation of
benzoxaborole active ingredients unpredictable and difficult relative to traditional, non-boron containing, organic molecules. This Lewis acidic center readily interacts with formulation components (solvents, surfactants, and other adjuvants) in unexpected ways. Accordingly, the formulation of benzoxaborole active ingredients requires novel approaches that heretofore have not been developed or considered for the formulation of traditional, non-boron containing agricultural or therapeutic formulations.
[0014] Therefore, there is a need for formulations comprising benzoxaboroles for the treatment of crops to control pathogenic infection to make this class of chemistry applicable beyond simple in vitro assays. While benzoxaborole formulations can be used in multiple applications, a preferred application is agricultural use. Moreover, these benzoxaborole formulations may be coupled with known active ingredients, or other additives to increase efficacy, stability, combat resistance, and/or spectrum broadening.
BRIEF SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0015] In a first aspect of the invention, a benzoxaborole formulation composition comprises a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond. The carrier is a solid or a liquid. [0016] In a feature of this aspect, the benzoxaborole has a structure (lb):
Figure imgf000007_0001
[0017] wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; and W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine. The benzoxaborole may be a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer of the compound of structure (lb).
[0018] In another feature of this aspect, the benzoxaborole has a structure (Ic):
Figure imgf000007_0002
[0019] wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine. The benzoxaborole may be a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer of the compound of structure (Ic).
[0020] With regard to this feature, Y can be selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, and hydrogen. In a feature of this aspect, the benzoxaborole is:
Figure imgf000007_0003
, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0021] In a feature of this aspect, the non-ionic and ionic surfactants are independently selected from the group consisting of: high molecular weight polymers, polycondensates of ethylene oxide with fatty alcohols or with fatty acids or with fatty amines, substituted phenols (in particular alkylphenols or arylphenols such as mono- and di-(polyoxyalkylene alkylphenol), polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphate tristyrylphenols and polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphoric esters of alcohols or phenols, amine ethoxylates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil, sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, sorbitan monolaurate, sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan monolaurates, non-ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary alcohol ethoxylates, nonylphenol ethoxylates, octylphenol ethoxylates, fatty alcohol ethoxylates, alkyl phenol ethoxylates, castor oil based ethoxylates, fatty acid ethoxylates, EO-PO block co-polymers, acrylic co-polymers, styrene acrylic polymers, polyalkylene oxide block copolymers, sorbitan(ol) ester ethoxylates, sarcosinates, alkyl polysaccrharides, alkyl amine ethoxylates, amine oxides, siliconics, ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, propoxylated and non-ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, alkyl ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether sulphates, condensed naphthalene sulfonates and salts, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blends, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulfonate, sodium alkylnapthalene formaldehyde condensates, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acids, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic salts, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic blends, fatty alcohol sulphates, alkyl ether carboxylic acids, alkyl ether carboxylic salts, alkyl ether sulphates, monosulphosuccinates, polysulphosuccinates, alkyl phosphates, alkyl benzene sulphonic acids, alkyl benzene sulphonic salts, lignosulphonates and salts, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, and alpha olefin sulphonates.
[0022] With regard to this feature, the pKa of the benzoxaborole is between 6 and 10, preferably between 6 and 8.
[0023] In another feature of this aspect, the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the
benzoxaborole formulation is 5% to 60% w/w if the carrier is a liquid, and the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 20% to 99.9% w/w if the carrier is a solid. Preferably, the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 10% to 50% w/w if the carrier is a liquid, and the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the
benzoxaborole formulation is 20% to 80% w/w if the carrier is a solid.
[0024] In an additional feature of this aspect, the concentration of surfactant in the
benzoxaborole formulation is between 0.1% and 35% w/w. In another feature of this aspect, the composition further comprises an antioxidant.
[0025] In yet another feature of this aspect, the carrier is a liquid and comprises a solvent selected from the group consisting of: a protic solvent, water, C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof, alcohols, ethylene glycol monomethyl ether, or a mixture thereof. With regard to this feature, the carrier further comprises a second liquid carrier selected from the group consisting of: an aprotic solvent, a ketone, cyclohexanone, isophorone, or N- methyl-2-pyrrolidone. The carrier may comprise a mixture of a protic solvent and an aprotic solvent, preferably the aprotic solvent is polar. Morever, the carrier may be a solid.
[0026] In a feature of this aspect, the benzoxaborole formulation is an emulsion concentrate (EC), a suspension concentrate (SC), a wettable powder (WP), a water dispersible granule (WDG), or a seed treatment. The formulation composition may further comprise an aqueous diluent. The aqueous diluent may have a pH between about 5.5 and 9.5, for example, between about 6 and 8.
[0027] In another feature of the aspect, the composition further comprises at least one fungicide selected from the group consisting of: carbendazim, thiabendazole, thiophanate, thiophanate- methyl, diethofencarb, zoxamide, ethaboxam, pencycuron, flupicolide, flutolanil, fluopyram, fluxapyroxad, penthiopyrad, benodanil, mepronil, isofetamid, fenfuram, carboxin, oxycarboxin, thifluzamide, benzovindiflupyr, bixafen, furametpyr, isopyrazam, penflufen, sedaxane, boscalid, benomyl, fuberidazole, diflumetorim, tolfenpyrad, azoxystrobin, coumoxystrobin, enoxastrobin, flufenoxystrobin, picoxystrobin, pyraoxystrobin, mandestrobin, pyraclostrobin, pyrametostrobin, triclopyricarb, kresoxim-methyl, trifloxystrobin, dimeoxystrobin, fenamistrobin,
methominostrobin, orysastrobin, famoxadone, fluoxastrobin, fenamidone, pyribencarb, cyazofamid, amisulbrom, binapacryl, meptyldinocap, dinocap, fluazinam, fentin chloride, fentin acetate, fentin hydroxide, silthiofam, ametoctradin, cyprodinil, mepanipyrim, pyrimethanil, kasugamycin, quinoxyfen, proquinazid, fenpiclonil, fludioxonil, chlozolinate, dimethachlone, iprodione, procymidone, vinclozolin, triforine, pyrifenox, pyrisoxazole, fenarimol, nuarimol, imazalil, oxpoconazole, pefurazoate, prochloraz, triflumizole, azaconazole, bitertanol,
bromuconazole, cyproconazole, diniconazole, epoxiconazole, etanconazole, fenbuconazole, fluquinconazole, flusilazole, flutriafol, hexaconazole, imibenconazole, ipconazole, metconazole, myclobutanil, penconazole, propiconazole, simeconazole, tebuconazole, tetraconazole, triadimefon, triadimenol, triticonazole, prothioconazole, aldimorph, dodemorph, fenpropimorph, tridemorph, fenpropidin, piperalin, spiroxamine, fenhexamid, fenpyrazamine, pyributicarb, naftifine, terbinafine, validamycin, polyoxin, dimethomorph, flumorph, pyrimorph, benthiavalicarb, iprovalicarb, valifenalate, mandipropamid, ferbam, macozeb, maneb, metiram, propineb, thiram, zineb, ziram, captan, captafol, folpet, dichlofluanid, tolylfluanid, and chlorothalonil.
[0028] In an additional feature of the aspect, the composition further comprises at least one insecticide/nematicide selected from the group consisting of: avermectin group, such as abamectin; carbamate group, such as, aldicarb, thiadicarb, carbofuran, carbosulfan, oxamyl, aldoxycarb, ethoprop, methomyl, benomyl, alanycarb; and organophosphorus group, such as, fenamiphos, fensulfothion, terbufos, fosthiazate, dimethoate, phosphocarb, dichlofenthion, isamidofos, fosthietan, isazofos ethoprophos, cadusafos, terbufos, chlorpyrifos, dichlofenthion, heterophos, isamidofos, mecarphon, phorate, thionazin, triazophos, diamidafos, fosthietan, phosphamidon, and dichloropropene.
[0029] Additionally, the composition may comprise at least one insecticide selected from the group consisting of: a phenylpyrazole group, such as ethiprole and fipronil; a pyrethroid group, such as acrinathrin, allethrin, bifenthrin, bioallenthrin, bioresmethrin, cycloprothrin, cyfluthrin, cyhalothrin, cypermethrin, cyphenothrin, deltamethrin, esfenvalerate, etofenprox, fenpropathrin, fenvalerate, flucythrinate, flumethrin, halfenprox, imiprothrin, kadethrin, permethrin, prallethrin, pyrethrins, resmethrin, silafluofen, tefluthrin, tetramethrin, tetramethrin, tralomethrin, and transfluthrin; and a neonicotinoid group: such as acetamiprid, clothianidin, dinotefuran, imidacloprid, nitenpyram, thiacloprid, and thiamethoxam; and a spinosyn group: such as spinetoram and spinosad.
[0030] In a second aspect of the invention, a method of controlling a phytopathogenic disease on crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material comprises applying an effective amount of the composition of the first aspect to said crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material.
[0031] In a third aspect of the invention, a method of controlling a phytopathogenic disease on crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material comprises applying an effective amount of the composition of the first aspect, wherein said application is topical, to the soil, foliar, a foliar spray, systemic, a seed coating, a soil drench, directly in-furrow dipping, drenching, soil drenching, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), and/or drip irrigating.
[0032] In a fourth aspect of the invention, a benzoxaborole compound is represented by formula
(I):
Figure imgf000011_0001
wherein:
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, CF3, Ethyl, OCH3, OCF3, OCF2H, CFFh, OEthyl, O-n-propyl, O-n-butyl, O-iso- propyl, O-sec -butyl, O-iso-butyl, O-cyclopropyl, O-cyclbutyl, C(0)H, CN, CH2OH, SR1, and S(0)R1, wherein R1 is selected from C1-C3
hydrocarbyl;
X is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, R2, OR2, OCF2H, NR22, NHR2, NH2, halogen, CO2R2, CN, OH, CH2OH, N02, C(0)H, SR2, and S(0)R2, wherein each R2 is independently selected from C1-C7
hydrocarbyl and C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl or each R2 can be taken together to form a ring;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, NO2, C(0)H, and CO2R3, wherein R3 is selected from C1-C4 hydrocarbyl and C3-C4 cyclohydrocarbyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, R4, NR42, NHR4, NH2, NO2, CO2R4, OR4, OH, OCF2H, SR4, and S(0)R4, wherein R4 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl and C3 cyclohydrocarbyl; and
V and V’ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and
CH ,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof. [0033] In a fifth aspect of the invention, a benzoxaborole compound is represented by formula Ial:
Figure imgf000012_0001
wherein:
Ri is equal to R2, or Ri is not equal to R2, and
Ri and/or R2 are selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, and pentyl, or
Ri and R2 are taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring; and each Xa is independently selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0034] In a sixth aspect of the invention, a benzoxaborole compound is represented by formula Iall:
Figure imgf000012_0002
wherein: each R12 or R13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl, C3-C6 cyclohydrocabyl, -CH2CºCR4 a , - CH2CºCPh, CH2CºCCH2Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R4 a substitutions; or R12 and R13 taken together, form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; each Xa is independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; each Ya is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; and each R4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0035] In a seventh aspect of the invention, the benzoxaborole compound is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000013_0001
Figure imgf000014_0001

Figure imgf000015_0001

Figure imgf000016_0001

Figure imgf000017_0001

Figure imgf000018_0001

Figure imgf000019_0001

Figure imgf000020_0001
, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0036] In a feature of the sixth aspect, at least one of R12 and R13 is -CH2CºCR4 a, wherein R4 a is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl. In another feature of the sixth aspect, at least one of R12 and R13 is -CH2CºCPh or CH2CºCCH2Ph.
[0037] In a feature of the fifth aspect, the compound is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000020_0002
Figure imgf000021_0001

Figure imgf000022_0002
, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0038] In an eighth aspect of the invention, an emulsion concentrate formulation composition comprises a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a liquid carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the liquid carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
[0039] In a feature of the eighth aspect, the benzoxaborole is:
Figure imgf000022_0001
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0040] The another feature of the eighth aspect, the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent. Additionally, the liquid carrier may comprise a mixture of a protic solvent and an aprotic solvent. The aprotic solvent may be a polar aprotic solvent or a non-polar aprotic solvent.
[0041] In a ninth aspect of the invention, a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen comprises applying a compound according to any aspect of the invention, wherein the pathogen is selected from a group consisting of: insects, nematodes, bacteria, microbes, fungi, protozoa, viruses, and parasites, or any combinations thereof. With regard to the method, the compound may be applied to an animal, a plant, a plant part, seeds, or plant propagation material.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF FIGURES
[0042] FIG. 1 is an image of the 'H-NMR spectra recorded in association with Example 22 of the formulation examples. [0043] FIG. 2A-2I is a table that provides chemical characterization data for a number of exemplary benzoxaborole compounds, including some of those for which synthesis is described in the Syntheses Examples Section.
[0044] FIG. 3A-3TT is a table showing antifungal and antibacterial inhibition results for a number of exemplary boron-based compounds as described in Example 3 and Example 4 of the Biological Materials and Methods examples.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION Definitions
[0045] The phrases“at least one”,“one or more”, and“and/or” are open-ended expressions that are both conjunctive and disjunctive in operation. For example, each of the expressions“at least one of A, B and C”,“at least one of A, B, or C”,“one or more of A, B, and C”,“one or more of A, B, or C” and“A, B, and/or C” means A alone, B alone, C alone, A and B together, A and C together, B and C together, or A, B and C together.
[0046] The term“a” or“an” entity refers to one or more of that entity. As such, the terms“a” (or“an”),“one or more” and“at least one” can be used interchangeably herein. It is also to be noted that the terms“comprising”,“including”, and“having” can be used interchangeably.
[0047] As used herein, the term "hydrocarbyl" is a short hand term for a non-aromatic group that includes straight and branched chain aliphatic as well as alicyclic groups or radicals that contain only carbon and hydrogen. Inasmuch as alicyclic groups are cyclic aliphatic groups, such substituents are deemed to be subsumed within the aliphatic groups. Thus, alkyl, alkenyl, and alkynyl groups are contemplated.
[0048] Exemplary hydrocarbyl groups contain a chain of 1 to about 6 carbon atoms, and more preferably 1 to 4 carbon atoms. Examples of hydrocarbyl radicals include methyl, ethyl, n- propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, sec butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl, iso-amyl, hexyl, and the like. Examples of suitable alkenyl radicals include ethenyl (vinyl), 2 propenyl, 3 propenyl, 1,4- pentadienyl, 1,4 butadienyl, l-butenyl, 2-butenyl, 3-butenyl, and the like. Examples of alkynyl radicals include ethynyl, 2-prop ynyl, 3 propynyl, decynyl, 1 butynyl, 2-butynyl, 3-butynyl, and the like. [0049] An alkyl group is a preferred hydrocarbyl group. As a consequence, a generalized, but more preferred substituent can be recited by replacing the descriptor "hydrocarbyl" with "alkyl" in any of the substituent groups enumerated herein. Where a specific aliphatic hydrocarbyl substituent group is intended, that group is recited; i.e., C1-C4 alkyl, methyl, or dodecenyl.
[0050] A contemplated cyclohydrocarbyl substituent ring contains 3 to 6 carbon atoms. The term "cycloalkylalkyl" means an alkyl radical as defined above that is substituted by a cycloalkyl radical. Examples of such cycloalkyl radicals include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, and the like.
[0051] Usual chemical suffix nomenclature is followed when using the word "hydrocarbyl" except that the usual practice of removing the terminal "yl" and adding an appropriate suffix is not always followed because of the possible similarity of a resulting name to that of one or more substituents. Thus, a hydrocarbyl ether is referred to as a "hydrocarbyloxy" group rather than a "hydrocarboxy" group as may possibly be more proper when following the usual rules of chemical nomenclature. Illustrative hydrocarbyloxy groups include methoxy, ethoxy, and cyclohexenyloxy groups. On the other hand, a hydrocarbyl group containing a C(O)- functionality is referred to as a hydrocarboyl (acyl) and that containing a -C(0)0- is a hydrocarboyloxy group inasmuch as there is no ambiguity. Exemplary hydrocarboyl and hydrocarboyloxy groups include acyl and acyloxy groups, respectively, such as formyl, acetyl, propionyl, butyryl, valeryl, 4 methylvaleryl, and acetoxy, acryloyl, and acryloyloxy.
[0052] The term "halogen" or“halo” means fluorine, chlorine, bromine, or iodine. The term "halohydrocarbyl" means a hydrocarbyl radical as defined above wherein one or more hydrogens is replaced with a halogen. A halohydrocarbyl radical (group or substituent) is typically a substituted alkyl substituent. Examples of such haloalkyl radicals include chloromethyl, 1- bromoethyl, fluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, l,l,l-trifluoroethyl, and the like.
[0053] The term "perfluorohydrocarbyl" means an alkyl group wherein each hydrogen has been replaced by a fluorine atom. Examples of such perfluorohydrocarbyl groups, in addition to trifluoromethyl above, are perfluorobutyl, perfluoroisopropyl, and perfluorohexyl.
[0054] The abbreviation“Ph” means a phenyl group (C6H5) group. [0055] The phrase“True Fungi” is used herein for all of the fungal organisms discussed herein except for the Oomycota (such as Pythium, Phytophthora and Plasmopara). The uncaptialized term“fungi” or“fungus” is used to include all of the fungal organisms discussed herein, including the Oomycota.
[0056] In general,“pesticidal” means the ability of a substance to increase mortality, inhibit the growth rate, or eliminate the presence of plant pests. The term is used herein, to describe the property of a substance to exhibit activity against insects, mites, nematodes, fungi, bacteria, viruses, and/or phytopathogens. The term“pests” include insects, mites, nematodes, fungi, bacteria, viruses, and/or phytopathogens.
[0057] The term "health of a plant" or "plant health" is defined as a condition of the plant and/or its products. As a result of the improved health, yield, plant vigor, quality and tolerance to abiotic or biotic stress are increased. The health of a plant, when applying the active ingredients described herein, is increased independently of the pesticidal properties of the active ingredients used because the increase in health is not only based upon the reduced pest pressure but also on complex physiological and metabolic reactions that result, for example, in an activation of the plant's own natural defense system. As a result, the health of a plant is increased even in the absence of pest pressure.
[0058] “Insecticides” as well as the term“insecticidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality or inhibit growth rate of insects. As used herein, the term“insects” includes all organisms in the class“Insecta.” The term“pre-adult” insects refers to any form of an organism prior to the adult stage, including, for example, eggs, larvae, and nymphs.
[0059] “Nematicides” and“nematicidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality or inhibit the growth rate of nematodes. In general, the term“nematode” comprises eggs, larvae, juvenile, and mature forms of said organism.
[0060] “Acaricide” and“acaricidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality or inhibit growth rate of ectoparasites belonging to the class Arachnida, sub-class Acari.
[0061] “Fungicide” and“fungicidal” refers to the ability of a substance to increase mortality, control or inhibit growth rate of Fungi. Fungicidal abilities may be preventative, curative, or a combination thereof. [0062] By“effective” amount of an active ingredient, compound, drug, formulation, or permeant is meant a sufficient amount of an active agent to provide the desired local or systemic effect. A“topically effective” or“therapeutically effective” amount refers to the amount of compound or drug needed to effect the desired therapeutic result.
[0063] The term“agriculturally acceptable salt” is meant to include a salt of a compound of the invention which are prepared with relatively nontoxic acids or bases, depending on the particular substituents found on the compounds described herein. When compounds of the invention contain relatively acidic functionalities, base addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired base, either neat or in a suitable inert carrier. Examples of agriculturally acceptable base addition salts include sodium, potassium, calcium, ammonium, organic amino (such as choline or diethylamine or amino acids such as d-arginine, l-arginine, d-lysine, or l-lysine), or magnesium salt, or a similar salt. When compounds of the invention contain relatively basic functionalities, acid addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired acid, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable acid addition salts include those derived from inorganic acids like hydrochloric, hydrobromic, nitric, carbonic, monohydrogencarbonic, phosphoric, monohydrogenphosphoric,
dihydrogenphosphoric, sulfuric, monohydrogensulfuric, hydriodic, or phosphorous acids and the like, as well as the salts derived from relatively nontoxic organic acids like acetic, propionic, isobutyric, maleic, malonic, benzoic, succinic, suberic, fumaric, lactic, mandelic, phthalic, benzenesulfonic, p-tolylsulfonic, citric, tartaric, methanesulfonic, and the like. Also included are salts of amino acids such as arginate and the like, and salts of organic acids like glucuronic or galactunoric acids and the like (see, for example, Berge et ah,“Pharmaceutical Salts”, Journal of Pharmaceutical Science 66: 1-19 (1977)). Certain specific compounds of the invention contain both basic and acidic functionalities that allow the compounds to be converted into either base or acid addition salts.
[0064] The term“agriculturally acceptable excipient” is conventionally known to mean agriculturally acceptable carriers, agriculturally acceptable diluents and/or agriculturally acceptable vehicles used in formulating compositions effective for the desired use. [0065] The term“agriculturally acceptable carrier” or“agriculturally acceptable vehicle” or “carrier” refers to any medium that provides the appropriate delivery of an effective amount of an active agent(s) as defined herein, does not negatively interfere with the effectiveness of the biological activity of the active agent, and that is sufficiently non-toxic to the host. The term is used herein to denote a natural or synthetic, organic, or inorganic material that constitutes a portion of the diluent medium in which the benzoxaborole is dispersed or dissolved. This carrier is inert and agriculturally acceptable, in particular to the plant being treated. The phrase “agriculturally acceptable” is utilized herein to be analogous to“pharmaceutically acceptable” as used in pharmaceutical products to describe diluent media. A carrier, agriculturally acceptable carrier, or agriculturally acceptable vehicle can be solid (clays, natural or synthetic silicates, silica, resins, waxes, solid fertilizers, and the like) or liquid (water, alcohols, ketones, petroleum fractions, aromatic or paraffinic hydrocarbons, chlorinated hydrocarbons, liquefied gases, and the like). In the presently disclosed formulations, carriers may be solid or liquid, and may comprise a Lewis base, or a N-H or O-H bond. Additional information concerning carriers can be found in Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 21 st Ed., Lippincott, Williams & Wilkins (2005), which is incorporated herein by reference.
[0066] The term“formulation” refers to a mixture that may be solid or liquid comprising a benzoxaborole and at least one of agriculturally acceptable carriers, solvents, adjuvants, wetting agents, surfactants, and the like. The term "formulation” refers both to concentrated
formulations and diluted or applied formulations depending on the desired
administration/application. Examples of formulations include: wettable powders (WP), water dispersible granules (WG or WDG), soluble concentrates (SL), suspension concentrates (SC), emulsifiable/emulsion-concentrates (EC), concentrated aqueous emulsions (EW),
microemulsions (ME), suspoemulsion (SE), oil dispersions (OD), microencapuslted particles (CS), soil applied granule on inters or fertilizer carriers (GR), seed treatments, pre-mixes, tank- mixes, dosage formulations, etc.
[0067] The term“surfactant” or“surfactants” generally refers to compounds or substances that lower surface tension between between two liquids, a gas and a liquid, or a liquid and a solid. Surfactants generally may act as surface active agents, wetting agents, dispersing agents, other adjuvants, and the like. [0068] The term“Lewis Acid” refers to a compound or ionic species that can accept an electron pair from a donor compound (for example, a Lewis Base). A Lewis Acid is capable of accepting an electron pair from a Lewis Base to form a Lewis adduct.
[0069] The term“Lewis Base” refers to a compound or ionic species that can donate an electron pair to an acceptor compound (for example, a Lewis Acid). A Lewis Base is capable of donating an electron pair to a Lewis Acid to form a Lewis adduct.
Compounds
[0070] Benzoxaborole compounds and methods of using the benzoxaborole compounds are described herein. As will be discussed in greater detail below, exemplary embodiments of the compound are particularly useful in agricultural or therapeutic applications (e.g., as
phytopathogenic and/or infectious agent control, growth enhancement or control).
[0071] In one embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (I):
Figure imgf000028_0001
wherein:
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, CF3, Et,
OCH3, OCF3, OCF2H, CFFh, OEt, O-n-propyl, O-n-butyl, O-iso-propyl, O-sec-butyl, O-iso-butyl, O-cyclopropyl, O-cyclbutyl, C(0)H, CN, CFbOH, SR1, and S(0)R1, wherein R1 is selected from C1-C3
hydrocarbyl;
X is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, R2, OR2, OCF2H, NR2 2, NHR2, NH2, halogen, C02R2, CN, OH, CH2OH, N02, C(0)H, SR2, and S(0)R2, wherein each R2 is independently selected from C1-C7 hydrocarbyl and C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl or each R2 can be taken together to form a ring; Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, N02, C(0)H, and CO2R3, wherein R3 is selected from C1-C4 hydrocarbyl and C3-C4 cyclohydrocarbyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, R4, NR4 2, NHR4, NH2, N02, C02R4, OR4, OH, OCFIH, SR4, and S(0)R4, wherein R4 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl and C3 cyclohydrocarbyl; and
V and V’ are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and
CH3,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0072] Exemplary embodiments of the benzoxaborole compound include the following:
Figure imgf000029_0001
Figure imgf000030_0001

Figure imgf000031_0001

Figure imgf000032_0001
30
Figure imgf000033_0001
31
Figure imgf000034_0001
32
Figure imgf000035_0001
33
Figure imgf000036_0001

Figure imgf000037_0001

Figure imgf000038_0001

Figure imgf000039_0002
[0073] The above exemplary embodiments may also be or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0074] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Ial):
Figure imgf000039_0001
wherein:
Ri is equal to R2, or Ri is not equal to R2, and
Ri and/or R2 are selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, and pentyl, or
Ri and R2 are taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring, and each Xa is independently selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof. [0075] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Iall):
Figure imgf000040_0001
wherein: each R12 or R13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl, C3-C6 cyclohydrocabyl, -CH2CºCR4 a, CH2CºCPh, CH2CºCCH2Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R4 a substitutions; or R12 and R13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to;
Xa is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine;
Ya is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and each R4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0076] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula
(Mil):
Figure imgf000040_0002
wherein: each R12 or R13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl , C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl, -CH2Cº CR4 a, CH2CºCPh, CH2CºCCH2Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R4 a substitutions; or R12 and R13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; and each R4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of: alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0077] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (IalV):
Figure imgf000041_0001
wherein: each R12 or R13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl , C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl, -CH2CºCR4 a , CH2CºCPh CH2CºCCH2Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R4 a substitutions; or R12 and R13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; each R4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0078] In another embodiment, the disclosure includes a benzoxaborole formula (IaV):
Figure imgf000041_0002
wherein: each R12 or R13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl, C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl, -CH2CºCR4 a, CH2CºCPh, CH2CºCCH2Ph and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R4 a substitutions; or R12 and R13 may be taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; each R4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0079] Exemplary embodiments of the benzoxaborole compound are shown in Table A. Each compound in Table A can be represented by the formula (Ial). In some embodiments, the compound selected from Table A may be a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0080] Table A. Exemplary Embodiments of Benzoxaborole Compounds
Figure imgf000042_0001
Figure imgf000043_0001
41
Figure imgf000044_0003
[0081] In yet another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula
(lb):
Figure imgf000044_0001
wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0082] In another embodiment, of a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb) is an embodiment where W is hydrogen and Y is hydrogen or a salt thereof.
[0083] In another embodiment, of a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb) is an embodiment where W is hydrogen and Y is fluorine or a salt thereof.
[0084] An exemplary embodiment of a benzoxaborole compound of formula lb is an embodiment wherein W is hydrogen and Y is chlorine or a salt thereof. This embodiment has a chemical name (IUPAC name) of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol. This exemplary compound may be referred to herein as BAG8:
Figure imgf000044_0002
5-chlorobenzo[c][1 ,2]oxaborol-1 (3H)-o\
“BAG8” [0085] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Ic):
Figure imgf000045_0001
wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0086] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Id):
Figure imgf000045_0002
wherein Ra is selected from the group consisting of: methyl, ethyl, trimethylsilyl, isopropyl, and n-propyl,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0087] In yet another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula
(Ie):
Figure imgf000045_0003
wherein Y is a halogen and W is selected from the group consisting of: OMe, OEt, O-n-Propyl, 0-n-Butyl,OCHF2.
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0088] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (If):
Figure imgf000045_0004
wherein R5 is selected from the group consisting of: a Cl -Cl 5 hydrocarbyl, CH2PI1, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, n-pentyl, iso pentyl, and n-decyl; and
Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0089] In another embodiment, a benzoxaborole compound can be represented by formula (Ig):
Figure imgf000046_0001
wherein R5 is selected from the group consisting of: a Cl -Cl 5 hydrocarbyl, CH2Ph, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, n-pentyl, iso pentyl, and n-decyl;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; and
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[0090] Without being bound by theory, it is believed that when in aqueous media, embodiments of benzoxaborole compounds described herein may be present in a reversible equilibrium with water or other nucleophiles or other Lewis Bases due the Lewis acidic nature of the trigonal planar boron center (e.g. equilibrium between A and B below). This dynamic equilibrium may be important for the biological activity of various species of the benzoxaborole compounds described herein. Exemplary species may include compounds of formula (A) and formula (B) below.
Figure imgf000046_0002
[0091] Benzoxaborole compounds may be present in free form, as a hydrate, as a salt, as a stereoisomer, as an enantiomer, or a tautomeric form; e.g., as an agronomically usable or an agrochemically acceptable salt form.
Methods of Use
[0092] The benzoxaborole compounds and the formulations comprising benzoxaborole compounds described herein can be useful in providing a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen. The pathogen may include insects, nematodes, bacteria, microbes, fungi, protozoa, viruses, parasites or any combinations thereof.
[0093] In another aspect, the benzoxaborole compounds and the formulations comprising them can be used in methods for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen by applying an effective amount of the compound or formulation, wherein the pathogen is a fungi.
[0094] In another aspect, the disclosure includes a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by pests and/or a pathogen by applying a compound according to any one of the above formulae or a formulation of a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is a bacteria.
[0095] In another aspect, the disclosure includes a method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by pests and/or a pathogen by applying a compound according to any one of the above formulae or a formulation of a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is an insect, nematode, bacteria, microbe, fungi, protozoa, virus, parasite or any combinations thereof.
[0096] Benzoxaborole compounds, for example, a compound according to any one of the above formulae, can be used in a method for controlling or preventing an infestation of pests and/or a pathogen by treating a plant, plant part, plant propagation material, or seeds. The pathogen may be a bacteria, microbe, fungi, or any combination thereof. Additionally, formulations of benzoxaborole compounds can be used in the same manner for controlling or preventing an infestation of pests and/or a pathogen by treating a plant, plant part, plant propagation material, or seeds. [0097] In general, bacterial pathogens may be classified as either gram-positive or gram-negative pathogens. Antibiotic compounds with activity against both gram-positive and gram-negative pathogens are generally regarded as having a broad spectrum of activity. The benzoxaborole compounds described herein are regarded as being active against gram-positive and/or gram negative bacterial pathogens.
[0098] Examples of gram-positive and gram-negative aerobic and anaerobic bacteria, include Staphylococci, Enterococci, Streptococci, Bacilli, Listeria, Haemophilus, Moraxella,
Mycobacteria, Staphylococci, Pseudomonas, Agrobacterium tumefaciens, and Escherichia.
[0099] Examples of fungi include: one or more members of the phyla of Ascomycota, Oomycota, Basidiomycota, and the subphylum Mucoromycotina.
[00100] The target fungi of the division Ascomycota include, for example, subdivision
Pezizomycotina and Taphrinomycotina which include Dothideomycetes, Leotiomycetes,
Sordariomycetes and Taphrinomycetes classes.
[00101] The target fungi of the phylum Ascomycota include , for example, subphylum selected from the group consisting of Dothideomycetes, Leotiomycetes, and Sordariomycetes.
[00102] The target fungi of the division Basidiomycota include, for example, subdivisions
Agaricomycotina, Pucciniomycotina, and Ustilaginomycotina.
[00103] In some embodiments, the one or more target fungi whose growth is to be controlled or prevented is selected from one or more of the group consisting of Zymoseptoria, Phaeosphaeria, Erysiphe, Blumeria, Sclerotinia, Botrytis, Cercospora, Alternaria, Verticillium, Fusarium, Magnaporthe, Colletotrichum, Phakopsora, Puccinia, Rhizoctonia, Pythium,
Plasmopara, Phytophthora, Aspergillus, Bipolaris, Candida, Cochliobolus, Dilophospora, Exserohilum, Mycosphaerella, Sclerophthora, Ustiligo, Melampsora, Oidiopsis, Phymatotrichum, Pyrenophora, Uncinula, Peronospora, Monolinia, Venturia, Phomopsis, Claviceps, Aspergillus, Dibotryon, Pseudoperonospora, Setosphaeria, and Podosphaera.
[00104] In some embodiments, the one or more target fungi whose growth is to be controlled or prevented is selected from one or more of the group consisting of Zymoseptoria , Phaeosphaeria, Erysiphe, Blumeria, Sclerotinia, Botrytis, Cercospora, Alternaria, Verticillium, Fusarium, Magnaporthe, Colletotrichum, Phakopsora, Puccinia, Rhizoctonia, Pythium, Plasmopara, Phytophthora, Aspergillus, Bipolaris, Candida, Cochliobolus, Dilophospora, Exserohilum, Mycosphaeralla, Sclerophthora, Ustiligo, Melampsora, Oidiopsis,
Phymatotrichum, Pyrenophora, Uncinula, and Peronospora.
[00105] The benzoxaborole compounds demonstrate antipathogenic activity, good plant tolerance, low toxicity to plants, while exhibiting minimal environmental impact. The
compounds are suitable for protecting seeds, plants, plant organs, and plant propagation material, for increasing harvest yields, for improving the quality and/or vigor of the harvested material, in protection of stored products and of materials. They can be employed as plant protection agents. Moreover, the benzoxaborole compounds and benzoxaborole formulations are active against normally sensitive and resistant species and against all or some stages of development.
Benzoxaborole Formulations
[00106] Formulations comprising a benzoxaborole compound are also described herein.
As will be described more fully below, the benzoxaborole formulations have several benefits and advantages.
[00107] In a first embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a
benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond. The carrier can be a solid or a liquid.
[00108] In another embodiment, a method of using a benzoxaborole formulation comprises administering the formulation to seeds, plants, plant parts, and plant propagation materials in need thereof. The formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound, a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond. The carrier can be a solid or a liquid.
[00109] A benzoxaborole formulation comprises the benzoxaborole compounds described herein; specifically, the benzoxaborole compounds represented by formulae (lb) and (Ic).
[00110] In an exemplary embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ic):
Figure imgf000050_0001
wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
[00111] In another exemplary embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ic):
Figure imgf000050_0002
wherein Y is chlorine.
[00112] In yet another embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb):
Figure imgf000050_0003
wherein:
Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
[00113] Due to the Lewis Acidic character of the boron in the benzoxaborole compound, the boron can readily form a covalent bond with Lewis bases that may be present in the formulation. The Lewis base may be, for example, a solvent, a surfactant, a carrier, or an adjuvant.
[00114] In the benzoxaborole formulation, the boron of the benzoxaborole compound, for example, the boron of the benzoxaborole of formula (Ic) may react with alcohol solvents (R5OH) present in the formulation to produce a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct (a Lewis adduct). An example reaction to form a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct is shown in Scheme 2.
Figure imgf000051_0003
Scheme 2.
[00115] Exemplary alcohol solvents include, but are not limited to: C1-C15 branched saturated or unsaturated alcohols, C1-C15 linear saturated or unsaturated alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof.
[00116] In another embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a
benzoxaborole compound of formula (If):
Figure imgf000051_0001
wherein the substituents are defined as shown above.
[00117] In the benzoxaborole formulation, the boron of the benzoxaborole compound, for example, the boron of the benzoxaborole of formula (lb) may react with alcohol solvents (R5OH) present in the formulation to produce a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct (a Lewis adduct). An example reaction to form a benzoxaborole-alcohol adduct is shown in Scheme 2A.
Figure imgf000051_0002
Scheme 2 A
[00118] Exemplary alcohol solvents include, but are not limited to: C1-C15 branched saturated or unsaturated alcohols, C1-C15 linear saturated or unsaturated alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof.
[00119] In another embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a
benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ig):
Figure imgf000052_0001
wherein the substituents are defined as shown above.
[00120] In another embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a mixture of a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ic) and a benzoxaborole compound of formula (If).
[00121] In another embodiment, the benzoxaborole formulation comprises a mixture of a benzoxaborole compound of formula (lb) and a benzoxaborole compound of formula (Ig).
[00122] Exemplary benzoxaborole-alcohol adducts include the reaction products of (lb) or
(Ic) and the alcohol solvents listed herein. Example benzoxaborole compounds of formula (If) are shown below:
Figure imgf000053_0001
[00123] In some embodiments, the benzoxaborole compound of the benzoxaborole formulation may exist as an equilibrium mixture of the benzoxaborole and the benzoxaborole- alcohol adduct. In other embodiments, the benzoxaborole compound of the benzoxaborole formulation may exist as an equilibrium mixture of neutral planar benzoxaborole and ionic tetrahedral benzoxaborole. Exemplary equilibria are shown in Scheme 3. These dynamic equilibrium may be important for the biological activity of the compounds of formula (lb) and formula (Ic).
Figure imgf000054_0001
Scheme 3.
[00124] The benzoxaborole formulation may also comprise a second anti-fungal compound. The second anti-fungal compound may be selected from a group of compounds with a preselected biochemical mode of action (MOA) as described by a FRAC Target Site Code. Preferably, the FRAC Target site code is selected from the group consisting of: B, C, D, E, G, H, and M. More preferably, the second anti-fungal compound has a FRAC Target Site Code selected from one or more of a FRAC groups consisting of Bl, B3, C3, C4, C6, Dl, El, E2, E3, Gl, H5, M4, and M5. The FRAC Target Site Code single number designations are 1, 22, 11, 21, 30, 9, 13, 12, 2, 3, 40, M4, and M5, respectively.
[00125] In a preferred embodiment, the second anti-fungal compound comprises one or more of a compound selected from the group consisting of: carbendazim, thiabendazole, thiophanate, thiophanate-methyl, diethofencarb, zoxamide, ethaboxam, pencycuron, flupicolide, flutolanil, fluopyram, fluxapyroxad, penthiopyrad, benodanil, mepronil, isofetamid, fenfuram, carboxin, oxycarboxin, thifluzamide, benzovindiflupyr, bixafen, furametpyr, isopyrazam, penflufen, sedaxane, boscalid, benomyl, fuberidazole, diflumetorim, tolfenpyrad, azoxystrobin, coumoxystrobin, enoxastrobin, flufenoxystrobin, picoxystrobin, pyraoxystrobin, mandestrobin, pyraclostrobin, pyrametostrobin, triclopyricarb, kresoxim-methyl, trifloxystrobin,
dimeoxystrobin, fenamistrobin, methominostrobin, orysastrobin, famoxadone, fluoxastrobin, fenamidone, pyribencarb, cyazofamid, amisulbrom, binapacryl, meptyldinocap, dinocap, fluazinam, fentin chloride, fentin acetate, fentin hydroxide, silthiofam, ametoctradin, cyprodinil, mepanipyrim, pyrimethanil, kasugamycin, quinoxyfen, proquinazid, fenpiclonil, fludioxonil, chlozolinate, dimethachlone, iprodione, procymidone, vinclozolin, triforine, pyrifenox, pyrisoxazole, fenarimol, nuarimol, imazalil, oxpoconazole, pefurazoate, prochloraz, triflumizole, azaconazole, bitertanol, bromuconazole, cyproconazole, diniconazole, epoxiconazole,
etanconazole, fenbuconazole, fluquinconazole, flusilazole, flutriafol, hexaconazole,
imibenconazole, ipconazole, metconazole, myclobutanil, penconazole, propiconazole,
simeconazole, tebuconazole, tetraconazole, triadimefon, triadimenol, triticonazole,
prothioconazole, aldimorph, dodemorph, fenpropimorph, tridemorph, fenpropidin, piperalin, spiroxamine, fenhexamid, fenpyrazamine, pyributicarb, naftifine, terbinafine, validamycin, polyoxin, dimethomorph, flumorph, pyrimorph, benthiavalicarb, iprovalicarb, valifenalate, mandipropamid, ferbam, macozeb, maneb, metiram, propineb, thiram, zineb, ziram, captan, captafol, folpet, dichlofluanid, tolylfluanid, and chlorothalonil.
[00126] The formulations described herein can be used to control many pathogens including fungi, bacteria, insects, and parasites for the benefit of seeds, plants, plant parts, and/or plant propagation material. The formulation or applied formulation may be administered systemically, topically, in the soil, as a seed treatment, or foliarly. In other embodiments, the formulation or applied formulation may be applied in any desired manner, such as in the form of a seed coating, soil drench, and/or directly in-furrow and/or as a foliar spray and applied either pre-emergence, post-emergence or both. In other words, the formulation can be applied to the seed, the plant or to harvested fruits and vegetables or to the soil, wherein the plant is growing or wherein it is desired to grow (i.e., the plant's locus of growth).
[00127] In some embodiments, the formulation is applied post-harvest by dipping, fogging, drenching, or soil drenching.
[00128] In some embodiments, the treatment of plants or plant parts (which includes seeds and plants emerging from the seed) and/or harvested fruits and vegetables with the
benzoxaborole formulation according to the invention is carried out directly or by action on their surroundings, habitat or storage space using customary treatment methods, for example dipping, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), drip irrigating. [00129] In a preferred embodiment, the formulation or applied formulation is applied foliarly.
[00130] The formulations may be selected from the following types of formulations: emulsifiable concentrates, coatable pastes, dilute emulsions, wettable powders, soluble powders, dusts, granulates, concentrated aqueous emulsions, suspension concentrates, oil dispersions, water dispersible granules, seed treatments, and also encapsulations/microencapsulations e.g. in substances. The formulations described herein may be directly sprayable. The formulations can also be further diluted to produce an applied formulation prior to being applied on plants or plant propagation materials. In some instances, the formulation is mixed with water to obtain the applied formulation. As with the type of the formulations, the methods of application, such as spraying, atomizing, dusting, scattering, coating or pouring, are chosen in accordance with the intended objectives and the prevailing circumstances. A contemplated formulation can also contain further components such as stabilizers, antifoams, viscosity regulators, binders or tackifiers as well as fertilizers, micronutrient donors, or other formulations or active ingredients for obtaining special effects.
[00131] Suitable diluent media and adjuvants (auxiliaries) for the formulation can be solid or liquid and are substances useful in formulation technology, e.g., natural or regenerated mineral substances, carriers, solvents, dispersants, wetting agents, tackifiers, thickeners, binders, or fertilizers. Such diluent media are for example described in WO 97/33890, which is hereby incorporated by reference. In the applied formulation, water-based (more than 50 weight percent water) diluent media are presently preferred and are used illustratively herein.
[00132] More particularly, the applied formulation can be employed in any conventional form, for example in the form of a powder, an emulsion, a microemulsion, a flowable
concentrate, a solution, a suspension, a water dispersible powder, a capsule suspension, a gel, a cream, an emulsion concentrate, a suspension concentrate, a suspo-emulsion (an emulsion containing both solid and liquid benzoxaborole agents in an aqueous medium), a capsule suspension, a water dispersible granule, an emulsifiable granule, a water in oil emulsion, an oil in water emulsion, a micro-emulsion, an oil dispersion, an oil miscible liquid, a soluble concentrate, an ultra-low volume suspension, an ultra-low volume liquid, a technical concentrate, a dispersible concentrate, a wettable powder, or any technically feasible formulation. [00133] The benzoxaborole formulations can be produced by one of skill in the art of boron-chemistry, e.g., by mixing the active ingredients with appropriate formulation inerts such as solid or liquid carriers and optional other formulating ingredients such as surface-active compounds (surfactants), biocides, anti-freeze agents, stickers, thickeners and compounds that provide adjuvancy effects, and the like. Also, conventional slow release formulations can be employed where long-lasting efficacy is intended. Particularly, applied formulations may be applied in spraying forms, such as water dispersible concentrates, wettable powders, emulsifiable concentrates, suspension concentration and granules, can contain surfactants such as wetting and dispersing agents and other compounds that provide adjuvancy effects.
[00134] Carriers may be solid or liquid, and may comprise a Lewis base, or a N-H or O-H bond.
[00135] Solid, particulate carriers that can be used, for example for dusts and dispersible powders, are kaolinite, lactose, calcite, talc, kaolin, diatomaceous earth, montmorillonite or attapulgite, highly-disperse silica, or absorptive polymers. Illustrative particulate, adsorptive carriers for granules include kaolinite, lactose, pumice, crushed brick, sepiolite or bentonite, montmorillonite-type clay, and exemplary nonsorbent carrier materials are calcite or dolomite.
A particulate solid formulation can also be prepared by encapsulation of a suitable mixture of fungicides, pesticides, or insecticides or by a granulation process that utilizes one or more of the above diluents or an organic diluent such as microcrystalline cellulose, rice hulls, wheat middlings, saw dust and the like. Illustrative granules can be prepared as discussed in US Patents No. 4,936,901, No. 3,708,573 and No. 4,672,065.
[00136] Suitable liquid carriers include: protic solvents, aprotic solvents, water, substituted aromatic hydrocarbons, in particular the fractions C8-C12, such as xylene mixtures or substituted naphthalenes, phthalic esters such as dibutyl or dioctyl phthalate, substituted aliphatic hydrocarbons such as limonene, alcohols and glycols as well as their ethers and esters such as ethylene glycol monomethyl ether, C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof, ketones such as cyclohexanone or isophorone, strongly polar solvents such as N-methyl- 2-pyrrolidone, dimethyl sulfoxide or dimethylformamide, and, if appropriate, and epoxidized vegetable oils such as soybean oil. If appropriate, the liquid carrier can be a naturally occurring essential oil, such as oils from citronella, castor, lemon, citrus fruits, and lemon grass. In a preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier comprises a Lewis Base such as a protic solvent. In a preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier comprises a Lewis Base such as an alcohol.
[00137] In a preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier is a mixture comprising more than one suitable liquid carrier. In another preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent or at least one alcohol selected from the group consisting of: C1-C15 branched alcohols (saturated or unsaturated), C1-C15 linear alcohols (saturated or unsaturated), benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, 1- hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof. In another preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier comprises at least one protic solvent and at least one aprotic solvent. Preferably, the aprotic solvent is polar. In another preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent, a polar aprotic solvent, and a non-polar aprotic solvent.
[00138] A polar aprotic solvent, as defined herein, has a relatively large dielectric constant and a relatively large dipole moment, but it does not participate in hydrogen bonding (i.e., no O- H or N-H bonds). Exemplary polar aprotic solvents include acetone, N,N-dimethylformamide (DMF), acetonitrile (MeCN), and dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), N-methyl-2-pyrrolidone (NMP), cyclohexanone, and isophorone.
[00139] A non-polar aprotic solvent, as defined herein, has a relatively small dielectric constant and a relatively small dipole moment. Exemplary non-polar aprotic solvents include aliphatic hydrocarbons, aromatic hydrocarbons, substituted aromatic hydrocarbons, xylene mixtures, substituted naphthalenes, substituted aliphatic hydrocarbons, limonene (single enantiomer or mixtures thereof), or a mixture thereof.
[00140] As defined herein, protic solvents are solvents that have a hydrogen atom bonded to an oxygen (i.e. comprises an O-H bond) or a nitrogen (i.e. comprises an N-H bond).
Exemplary protic solvent include: C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol (decyl alcohol), 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof. [00141] Suitable surface-active compounds (or surfactants) comprise non-ionic or ionic surfactants (cationic and/or anionic), may be a Lewis Base, may comprise an N-H bond, may comprise on O-H bond, and have good emulsifying, dispersing and wetting properties, depending mostly on the nature of the active ingredients. The term“surfactants” is also to be understood as meaning mixtures of at least one surfactant.
[00142] The surfactants customarily employed in formulation technology are described, inter alia, in the following publications: McCutcheon's Detergents and Emulsifiers Annual, MC Publishing Corp., Glen Rock, N.J., 1988; M. and J. Ash, Encyclopedia of Surfactants, Vol. I-III, Chemical Publishing Co., New York, 1980-1981.
[00143] At least one surfactant is often present when inert vehicles and/or carriers are not readily soluble in water. In a preferred embodiment, the surfactant is at least one of a(n): amine ethoxylates, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (for example polysorbate 20), sorbitan fatty acid esters such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan
monolaurates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, non-ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary alcohol ethoxylates, nonylphenol ethoxylates, and octylphenol ethoxylates.
[00144] Moreover, preferred non-ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, fatty alcohol ethoxylates, alkyl phenol ethoxylates, castor oil based ethoxylates (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (for example polysorbate 20), sorbitan fatty acid esters such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan
monolaurates, fatty acid ethoxylates, EO-PO block co-polymers, acrylic co-polymers, styrene acrylic polymers, polyalkylene oxide block copolymers, sorbitan(ol) ester ethoxylates, sarcosinates, alkyl polysaccarharides, alkyl amine ethoxylates, amine oxides, siliconics, ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, and propoxylated and non-ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers.
[00145] Additionally, preferred ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulfphonates, alkyl ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether sulphates, condensed naphthalene sulfonates and salts, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blends, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, sodium alkylnaphthalene sulfonate, sodium alkylnapthalene formaldehyde condensates, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acids, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic salts, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic blends, fatty alcohol sulphates, alkyl ether carboxylic acids, alkyl ether carboxylic salts, alkyl ether sulphates, monosulphosuccinates, polysulphosuccinates, alkyl phosphates, alkyl benzene sulphonic acids, alkyl benzene sulphonic salts, lignosulphonates and salts, and alpha olefin sulphonates.
[00146] Additionally, preferred non-ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to castor oil based ethoxylates (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), fatty acid ester ethoxylates such as Tween 21, Tween 20, Tween 85, Tween 60, and Tween 22, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (such as Tween 20, Tween 21, Tween 22), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates (such as Tween 20, Tween 21), polyoxyethylene sorbitan monostearates (such as Tween 60), polyoxyethylene sorbitan trioleates (such as Tween 85), and sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates (such as Tween 85), high molecular weight polymeric emulsifiers such as the star polymer ATLOX 4916, and sorbitan monolaurate. Exemplary preferred non-ionic surfactants include, for example, Tween 21, Tween 22, Tween 20, Tween 60, Tween 85, ATLOX 4916, and Span 20.
[00147] Preferred ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, for example ATLOX 4838B.
[00148] Furthermore, particularly useful adjuvants, which enhance application, are natural or synthetic phospholipids from the series of the cephalins and lecithins, for example phosphatidylethanolamine, phosphatidylserine, phosphatidylglycerine, or lysolecithin.
[00149] A contemplated formulation can also include at least one polymer that is a water-soluble or a water-dispersible, film-forming polymer that improves the adherence of the benzoxaborole compound to the treated material (e.g., seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation materials). In one preferred embodiment where the benzoxaborole compound is used to treat plant propagation material, the polymer is a styrene acrylic emulsion polymer.
[00150] Some contemplated formulations can include at least one antioxidant. Examples of antioxidants include, but are not limited to: glycine, glycinebetaine, choline salts, in particular choline chloride, 2(3)-tert-butyl-4-hydroxyanisole (BHA), tert-butylhydroxyquinone (TBHQ), dilauryl thiodipropionate (DLTDP), tris(nonylphenyl))phosphite (TNPP), 2,6-dihydroxybenzoic acid (DHBA), acetylsalicylic acid (ASA), salicylic acid (SA), Irganox 1076 (Ciba Geigy), Ethanox 330 (Ethyl Corp.), Tinuvin 144 (Ciba Geigy), Ambiol (2-methyl-4- [dimethylaminomethyl]-5-hydroxybenzimidazole), propyl gallate, trihydroxybutyrophenone (THBP), thiodipropionic acid and dilauryl thiodipropionate, betaines (see, AU-B-27071/95 to Bodapati, and EO 0 493 670 Al to Lunkenheimer et al.), amines (aromatic amines and hindered amines), methionine, cysteine, proline, mannitol, phosphites, thioesters, lecithin, gum or resin guiac, Vitamin E, polyphenols, Vitamin A, carotenoids (beta-carotene), Vitamin B, Vitamin C, tocopherols, alpha-lipoic acid, coenzyme Q10 CoQlO), grape seed extract, green tea, lutein, N- acetyl Cysteine (NAC), OPCs (pycnogenols), selenium, zinc, 2,6-di-tert-para-benzoquinone, abscisic acid, bioflavonoids, DMAE (N,N-Dimethylethanolamine, precursor of choline), metronidazole, 2-methyl-5-nitroimidazole, glyoxal, polymerized 2, 2, 4-trimethyl- 1,2- dihydroquinoline, 2-mercaptobenzimidazol, 5-tert-butyl-4-hydroxy-2-methyl-phenyl sulfide (CAS RN 96-69-5), 4-tert-butylphenol (CAS RN 98-54-4), catechol (CAS RN 120-80-9), 2- naphthol (2-hydroxynaphthalene) (CAS RN 135-19-3), octadecyl-3-(3',5'-di-tert-butyl-4- hydroxyphenyl)propionate (CAS RN 2082-79-3), l,3,5-trimethyl-2,4,6-tris(3,5-di-tert-butyl-4- hydroxybenzyl)benzene (CAS RN 1709-70-2), and tris-(2,4,-di-tert-butylphenyl)phosphite (CAS RN 31570-04-4).
[00151] In some embodiments, hindered phenol antioxidants are preferred. Examples of hindered phenol antioxidants include: 2,6-di-tert-butyl-p-cresol (BHT) (CAS RN 128-37-0), 2(3)-tert-butyl-4-hydroxyanisole (BHA), isobutylenated methylstyrenated phenol (CAS RN 68457-74-9), styrenated phenol (CAS RN 61788-44-1), 2,6-di-tert-butyl-4- (octadecanoxycarbonylethyl)phenol (CAS RN 2082-79-3), 4,4'-thiobis-6-(t-butyl-m-cresol) (CAS RN 96-69-5), 4,4'-butylidenebis(6-t-butyl-m-cresol) (CAS RN 85-60-9), 4,4'-(l- methylethylidene)bis[2-(l,l-dimethylethyl)]phenol (CAS RN 79-96-9), 2,2'-methylenebis(4- methyl-6-nonyl)phenol (CAS RN 7786-17-6), 4-methyl-phenol reaction products with dicyclopentadiene and isobutylene (CAS RN 68610-51-5), tetrakis-(methylene-(3,5-di-tertbutyl- 4-hydrocinnamate)methane (CAS RN 6683-19-8), tert-butylhydroxyquinone (TBHQ), Irganox 1076, Ethanox 330, and l,3,5-tris(3,5-di-tert-butyl-4-hydroxybenzyl-)-l,3,5-triazine- 2,4,6(lH,3H,5H)-trione (CAS RN 27676-62-6). [00152] Typically, a coloring agent, such as a dye or pigment, is included in the formulation so that an observer can immediately determine that the plant has been treated. An antifungal formulation that includes a coloring agent is a preferred embodiment of the invention as it can improve user and consumer safety. The coloring agent is also useful to indicate to the user the degree of uniformity of application. Generally, the coloring agent tends to have a melting point above 30 C, and therefore, is suspended in a contemplated formulation. The coloring agent can also be a soluble compound.
[00153] Examples of coloring agents include pigment red 48-2 (CAS-7023-61-2), pigment blue 15 (CAS-147-14-8), pigment green 7 (CAS-1328-53-6), pigment violet 23 (CAS- 6358-30-1), pigment red 53-1 (CAS-5160-02-1), pigment red 57-1 (CAS 5281-04-9), pigment red 112 (CAS 6535-46-2) or similar coloring agents. A coloring agent is typically present at about 0.1 to about 10% by mass of the formulation.
[00154] In typical use, the benzoxaborole formulation composition is preferably formulated as a concentrate also known as a pre-mix composition (or concentrate, formulated compound, or formulation), and the end user normally employs a diluted formulation or an applied formulation for administration to the plants, plant propagation material, seeds, or plant parts of interest. Such a diluted formulation is often referred to as a tank-mix composition or an applied formulation. A tank-mix composition or applied formulation is generally prepared by diluting a pre-mix or formulation comprising a benzoxaborole compound with a diluent such as water that can optionally also contain further auxiliaries. Generally, an aqueous tank-mix is preferred.
[00155] In general, a benzoxaborole formulation, in particular an emulsion concentrate, includes about 0.01 to about 90% by weight benzoxaborole, about 0 to about 20% agriculturally acceptable surfactant and 1 to 99.99% solid or liquid carriers and adjuvant(s). For example, the formulation may include about 0.01 to 60 wt%, about 1.0 to 60 wt%, about 1.0 to 50 wt%, about 1.0 to 30 wt%, about 1.0 to 10 wt%, about 5.0 to 60 wt%, about 10 to 60 wt%, about 20 to 60 wt%, about 5 to 20 wt%, or about 20 to 40 wt% benzoxaborole. The formulation may include up to about 20%, up to about 15%, up to about 10%, or up to about 5% surfactant. The formulation may include about 1 to 99%, about 40 to 99%, about 50 to 99%, about 60 to 95%, about 70 to 95%, or about 80 to 99% solid or liquid carriers and agriculturally acceptable surfactant.
[00156] As will be shown in the examples below, in some instances, the formulation components enhance the biological or pesticidal activity of the benzoxaborole compound. For example, the formulation components may enhance the biological activity of the benzoxaborole compound.
[00157] Additionally, in exemplary instances, some formulation components aid in formulation stability. Moreover, in exemplary instances, some formulation components aid in applied formulation stability. For example, as shown in the examples below, having a suitable mixture of protic solvent and aprotic solvent as formulation components in an emulsifiable concentrate can be helpful in achieving a stable emulsion. As explained above, a protic solvent is a Lewis Base, for example, an alcohol. A protic solvent is also a solvent that has a hydrogen atom bound to an oxygen or a nitrogen. Moreover, it was also previously explained that a preferred embodiment of the formulation includes a liquid carrier comprising at least one protic solvent and at least one aprotic solvent. Additionally, having a suitable mixture of protic and aprotic solvent can be helpful in achieving an emulsion with a desirable D90 particle size.
[00158] The ratio of protic solvent to aprotic solvent can vary. In embodiments, the ratio of protic solvent to aprotic solvent can be from about 20 to about 0.1. For example, the ratio can be from about 15 to about 0.25, from about 7 to about 0.25, from about 3 to about 0.25, or from about 1 to about 0.25. In other embodiments, the ratio of protic to aprotic solvent can be about 0.25, about 0.33, about 0.5, about 1, about 3, about 7, or about 15. In preferred embodiments, the ratio of protic to aprotic solvent is from about 1 to about 0.25, in particular, from about 1 to about 0.33.
[00159] The desirable D90 particle size varies and is dependent on the formulation type. For example, a desired particle size for an emulsion that is derived from an emulsion concentrate that has been diluted into water is less than about lOpm, less than about 5pm, less than about lpm, or between about 0.1 pm and 1.0 pm. For diluted emulsion concentrates/emulsions derived from emulsion concentrates, it is generally desirable for the D90 particle size to remain stable for the period of time within which the formulation would be applied by an end user. For example, it is desirable for the D90 to remain stable for time periods up to 24 hours after dilution of the EC formulation into water.
[00160] In other exemplary instances, the formulation components aid in solubility.
[00161] In other exemplary instances, the formulation components enhance the shelf life or shelf stability of the formulation. For example, it is also desirable for the D90 of the emulsion to be about the same when the emulsion concentrate is stored at room temperature (about 20°C), higher temperature (about 50°C), or lower temperature (about 0°C).
[00162] Additionally, for some formulations, the biological activity of the benzoxaborole formulation is higher than the biological activity of the same benzoxaborole compound alone. For example, a BAG8 compound may be more biologically active in a formulation than it is alone. While not being bound by theory, it is possible that the formulation components increase the biological activity of the benzoxaborole compound.
[00163] Suitable penetrants that may be used in the present context include all those substances which are typically used in order to enhance the penetration of active agrochemical compounds into plants. Penetrants in this context are defined in that, from the (generally aqueous) application liquor and/or from the spray coating, they are able to penetrate the cuticle of the plant and thereby increase the mobility of the active compounds in the cuticle. This property can be determined using the method described in the literature (Baur et al., 1997, Pesticide Science 51, 131-152). Examples include alcohol alkoxylates such as coconut fatty ethoxylate, or isotridecyl ethoxylate, fatty acid esters such as rapeseed or soybean oil methyl esters, fatty amine alkoxylates such as tallowamine ethoxylate, or ammonium and/or
phosphonium salts such as ammonium sulphate or diammonium hydrogen phosphate, for example.
[00164] The benzoxaborole content of the application forms prepared from the formulations after dilution may vary within wide ranges. The active compound concentration of the application forms may be situated typically between 0.00000001% and 95% by weight of active compound, between about 0.001% and 1% by weight, or preferably between about 0.01% and 0.30% by weight based on the weight of the application form. Application takes place in a customary manner adapted to the application forms. [0077] In another aspect of the present invention, the formulation as described above is used for reducing overall damage of seeds, plants, plant parts and plant propagation material, as well as losses in harvested fruits or vegetables caused by bacteria, fungi, insects, mites, nematodes, viruses, and/or phytopathogens.
[00165] Furthermore, in another aspect of the present invention, the formulations as described above increases the overall plant health.
[00166] The term“plant health” generally comprises various sorts of improvements of plants that are not connected to the control of pests. For example, advantageous properties that may be mentioned are improved crop characteristics including: emergence, crop yields, protein content, oil content, starch content, more developed root system, improved root growth, improved root size maintenance, improved root effectiveness, improved stress tolerance (e.g. against drought, heat, salt, UV, water, cold), reduced ethylene (reduced production and/or inhibition of reception), tillering increase, increase in plant height, bigger leaf blade, less dead basal leaves, stronger tillers, greener leaf color, pigment content, photosynthetic activity, less input needed (such as fertilizers or water), less seeds needed, more productive tillers, earlier flowering, early grain maturity, less plant verse (lodging), increased shoot growth, enhanced plant vigor, increased plant stand, and early and better germination.
[00167] Improved plant health preferably refers to improved plant characteristics including: crop yield, more developed root system (improved root growth), improved root size maintenance, improved root effectiveness, tillering increase, increase in plant height, bigger leaf blade, less dead basal leaves, stronger tillers, greener leaf color, photosynthetic activity, more productive tillers, enhanced plant vigor, and increased plant stand.
[00168] The formulations according to the present invention, as it pertains to crop protection, may be applied in any desired manner, such as in the form of a seed coating, soil drench, and/or directly in-furrow and/or as a foliar spray and applied either pre-emergence, post emergence or both. In other words, the formulations can be applied to the seed, the plant, plant parts, plant propagation material, or to harvested fruits and vegetables or to the soil wherein the plant is growing or wherein it is desired to grow (plant's locus of growth).
[00169] Preferably, the formulations according to the present invention are used for treating conventional or transgenic plants or seeds thereof. [00170] If not mentioned otherwise, the treatment of plants or plant parts (which includes seeds and plants emerging from the seed), harvested fruits and vegetables, with the formulations according to the invention, are carried out directly or by action on their surroundings, habitat or storage space using customary treatment methods, for example dipping, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), drip irrigating. It is furthermore possible to apply the formulation as sole- formulation or combined-formulations by the ultra-low volume method, or to inject the formulation according to the present invention as a formulation or as sole-formulations into the soil (in-furrow).
[00171] The term“plant to be treated” encompasses every part of a plant including its root system and the material— e.g., soil or nutrition medium— which is in a radius of at least 10 cm, 20 cm, 30 cm around the caulis or bole of a plant to be treated or which is at least 10 cm, 20 cm, 30 cm around the root system of said plant to be treated, respectively.
[00172] The application rate of the formulations to be employed or used according to the present invention may vary. The skilled person is able to find the appropriate application rate by way of routine experiments.
Seed Treatment
[00173] In another aspect of the present invention a seed treated with the formulations as described above is provided.
[00174] The control of insects, mites, nematodes, and/or phytopathogens by treating the seed of plants has been known for a long time and is a subject of continual improvements.
Nevertheless, the treatment of seed entails a series of problems which cannot always be solved in a satisfactory manner. Thus, it is desirable to develop methods for protecting the seed and the germinating plant that remove the need for, or at least significantly reduce, the additional delivery of crop protection compositions in the course of storage, after sowing or after the emergence of the plants. It is desirable, furthermore, to optimize the amount of active ingredient employed in such a way as to provide the best-possible protection to the seed and the
germinating plant from attack by insects, mites, nematodes and/or phytopathogens, but without causing damage to the plant itself by the active ingredient employed. In particular, methods for treating seed ought also to take into consideration the intrinsic insecticidal and/or nematicidal properties of pest-resistant or pest-tolerant transgenic plants, in order to achieve optimum protection of the seed and of the germinating plant with a minimal use of crop protection compositions.
[00175] The invention likewise relates to the use of the formulation of the invention for treating seed for the purpose of protecting the seed and the resultant plant against insects, mites, nematodes and/or phytopathogens.
[00176] Furthermore, the invention relates to seed which, following treatment with the formulation of the invention, is subjected to a film-coating process in order to prevent dust abrasion of the seed.
[00177] One of the advantages of the present invention is that, owing to the particular systemic properties of the formulations of the invention, the treatment of the seed with these formulations provides protection from insects, mites, nematodes and/or phytopathogens not only to the seed itself but also to the plants originating from the seed, after they have emerged. In this way, it may not be necessary to treat the crop directly at the time of sowing or shortly thereafter.
[00178] A further advantage is to be seen in the fact that, through the treatment of the seed with formulation of the invention, germination and emergence of the treated seed may be promoted.
[00179] It is likewise considered to be advantageous that the formulation of the invention may also be used, in particular, on transgenic seed.
[00180] The invention further relates to seed treatment formulations that comprise a benzoxaborole, and optionally one or more additional fungicides, nematicides, or mixtures thereof.
[00181] Exemplary additional fungicides include: carbendazim, thiabendazole, thiophanate, thiophanate-methyl, diethofencarb, zoxamide, ethaboxam, pencycuron, flupicolide, flutolanil, fluopyram, fluxapyroxad, penthiopyrad, benodanil, mepronil, isofetamid, fenfuram, carboxin, oxycarboxin, thifluzamide, benzovindiflupyr, bixafen, furametpyr, isopyrazam, penflufen, sedaxane, boscalid, benomyl, fuberidazole, diflumetorim, tolfenpyrad, azoxystrobin, coumoxystrobin, enoxastrobin, flufenoxystrobin, picoxystrobin, pyraoxystrobin, mandestrobin, pyraclostrobin, pyrametostrobin, triclopyricarb, kresoxim-methyl, trifloxystrobin,
dimeoxystrobin, fenamistrobin, methominostrobin, orysastrobin, famoxadone, fluoxastrobin, fenamidone, pyribencarb, cyazofamid, amisulbrom, binapacryl, meptyldinocap, dinocap, fluazinam, fentin chloride, fentin acetate, fentin hydroxide, silthiofam, ametoctradin, cyprodinil, mepanipyrim, pyrimethanil, kasugamycin, quinoxyfen, proquinazid, fenpiclonil, fludioxonil, chlozolinate, dimethachlone, iprodione, procymidone, vinclozolin, triforine, pyrifenox, pyrisoxazole, fenarimol, nuarimol, imazalil, oxpoconazole, pefurazoate, prochloraz, triflumizole, azaconazole, bitertanol, bromuconazole, cyproconazole, diniconazole, epoxiconazole, etanconazole, fenbuconazole, fluquinconazole, flusilazole, flutriafol, hexaconazole,
imibenconazole, ipconazole, metconazole, myclobutanil, penconazole, propiconazole, simeconazole, tebuconazole, tetraconazole, triadimefon, triadimenol, triticonazole,
prothioconazole, aldimorph, dodemorph, fenpropimorph, tridemorph, fenpropidin, piperalin, spiroxamine, fenhexamid, fenpyrazamine, pyributicarb, naftifine, terbinafine, validamycin, polyoxin, dimethomorph, flumorph, pyrimorph, benthiavalicarb, iprovalicarb, valifenalate, mandipropamid, ferbam, macozeb, maneb, metiram, propineb, thiram, zineb, ziram, captan, captafol, folpet, dichlofluanid, tolylfluanid, and chlorothalonil.
[00182] Exemplary nematicides include: of avermectin nematicides, such as abamectin; carbamate nematicides, such as, aldicarb, thiadicarb, carbofuran, carbosulfan, oxamyl, aldoxycarb, ethoprop, methomyl, benomyl, alanycarb; and organophosphorus nematicides, such as, fenamiphos, fensulfothion, terbufos, fosthiazate, dimethoate, phosphocarb, dichlofenthion, isamidofos, fosthietan, isazofos ethoprophos, cadusafos, terbufos, chlorpyrifos, dichlofenthion, heterophos, isamidofos, mecarphon, phorate, thionazin, triazophos, diamidafos, fosthietan, and phosphamidon, as well as dichloropropene.
[00183] It is also stated that the formulation of the invention may be used in
combination with agents of the phosphate technology, as a result of which, for example, colonization with symbionts is improved, such as rhizobia, mycorrhiza and/or endophytic bacteria, for example, is enhanced, and/or nitrogen fixation is optimized.
[00184] The formulations of the invention are suitable for protecting seed of any variety of plant which is used in agriculture, in greenhouses, in forestry or in horticulture. More particularly, the seed in question is that of cereals (e.g., wheat, barley, rye, oats and millet), maize, cotton, soybeans, rice, potatoes, sunflower, coffee, tobacco, canola, oilseed rape, beets (e.g., sugar beet and fodder beet), peanuts, vegetables (e.g., tomato, cucumber, bean, brassicas, onions and lettuce), fruit plants, lawns and ornamentals. Particularly important is the treatment of the seed of cereals (e.g., wheat, barley, rye and oats) maize, soybeans, cotton, canola, oilseed rape and rice.
[00185] As already mentioned above, the treatment of transgenic seed with the formulation of the invention is particularly important. The seed in question here is that of plants which generally contain at least one heterologous gene that controls the expression of a polypeptide having, in particular, insecticidal and/or nematicidal properties. These heterologous genes in transgenic seed may come from microorganisms such as Bacillus, Rhizobium,
Pseudomonas, Serratia, Trichoderma, Clavibacter, Glomus, or Gliocladium. The present invention is particularly suitable for the treatment of transgenic seed which contains at least one heterologous gene from Bacillus sp. With particular preference, the heterologous gene in question comes from Bacillus thuringiensis .
[00186] For the purposes of the present invention, the formulations of the invention are applied alone or in a suitable formulation to the seed. The seed is preferably treated in a condition in which its stability is such that no damage occurs in the course of the treatment. Generally speaking, the seed may be treated at any point in time between harvesting and sowing. Typically, seed is used which has been separated from the plant and has had cobs, hulls, stems, husks, hair or pulp removed. Thus, for example, seed may be used that has been harvested, cleaned and dried to a moisture content of less than 15% by weight. Alternatively, seed can also be used that after drying has been treated with water, for example, and then dried again.
[00187] When treating seed it is necessary, generally speaking, to ensure that the amount of the formulation of the invention, and/or of other additives, that is applied to the seed is selected such that the germination of the seed is not adversely affected, and/or that the plant which emerges from the seed is not damaged. This is the case in particular with active ingredients which may exhibit phytotoxic effects at certain application rates. [00188] The formulations of the invention can be applied directly, in other words without comprising further components, and without having been diluted. As a general rule, it is preferable to apply the formulations in the form of a suitable formulation to the seed.
[00189] The formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention may be converted into the customary seed-dressing formulations, such as solutions, emulsions, suspensions, powders, foams, slurries or other coating compositions for seed, and also ULV formulations.
[00190] These formulations are prepared by mixing the benzoxaborole and surfactant with customary adjuvants, such as, for example, customary extenders and also solvents or diluents, colorants, wetters, dispersants, emulsifiers, antifoams, antioxidants, preservatives, secondary thickeners, antifreezes, stickers, gibberellins, and also water.
[00191] Colorants which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all colorants which are customary for such purposes. In this context, it is possible to use not only pigments, which are of low solubility in water, but also water-soluble dyes. Examples include the colorants known under the designations Rhodamin B, C.I. Pigment Red 112 and C.I. Solvent Red 1.
[00192] Wetters, which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations and can be used in accordance with the invention, include all of the substances which promote wetting and which are customary in the formulation of active agrochemical ingredients. Use may be made preferably of alkylnaphthalenesulphonates, such as diisopropyl- or diisobutyl- naphthalenesulphonates .
[00193] Dispersants and/or emulsifiers which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations that can be used in accordance with the invention include all of the nonionic, anionic, and cationic dispersants that are customary in the formulation of active agrochemical ingredients. Use may be made preferably of nonionic or anionic dispersants or of mixtures of nonionic or anionic dispersants. Suitable nonionic dispersants are, in particular, ethylene oxide- propylene oxide block polymers, alkylphenol polyglycol ethers, polyalkylene oxide block co polymers, acrylic co-polymers and also tristryrylphenol polyglycol ethers, and the phosphate or sulphated derivatives of these. Suitable anionic dispersants are, in particular, lignosulphonates, salts of polyacrylic acid, and arylsulphonate-formaldehyde condensates. [00194] Antifoams which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all of the foam inhibitors that are customary in the formulation of active agrochemical ingredients. Use may be made preferably of silicone antifoams and magnesium stearate.
[00195] Antioxidants which may be present in the seed- dressing formulation are preferably those that have a low level of phy to toxicity. It is also preferred that the antioxidant that is used in the present method and formulations be one that is approved for use in food, feed, or cosmetics. Examples of such approval are approval by a regulatory body, such as the U.S. Food and Drug Administration for use in food or cosmetics, or approval by the U.S. Department of Agriculture for use. Antioxidants that have GRAS (Generally Recognized As Safe) status are examples of preferred antioxidants. In some embodiments of the present invention, it is preferred that the antioxidant is one that is added to the seed, as opposed to an antioxidant that is a natural component of the seed. However, such preferred antioxidants can include natural antioxidants that are added to the seed during the present treatment process.
[00196] Examples of materials that can serve as the antioxidant of the present invention include: glycine, glycinebetaine, choline salts, in particular choline chloride, 2(3)-tert-butyl-4- hydroxyanisole (BHA), tert-butylhydroxyquinone (TBHQ), dilauryl thiodipropionate (DLTDP), tris(nonylphenyl))phosphite (TNPP), 2,6-dihydroxybenzoic acid (DHBA), acetylsalicylic acid (ASA), salicylic acid (SA), Irganox 1076 (Ciba Geigy), Ethanox 330 (Ethyl Corp.), Tinuvin 144 (Ciba Geigy), Ambiol (2-methyl-4-[dimethylaminomethyl]-5-hydroxybenzimidazole), propyl gallate, trihydroxybutyrophenone (THBP), thiodipropionic acid and dilauryl thiodipropionate, betaines (see, AU-B-27071/95 to Bodapati, and EO 0 493 670 Al to Lunkenheimer et al.), amines (aromatic amines and hindered amines), methionine, cysteine, proline, mannitol, phosphites, thioesters, lecithin, gum or resin guiac, Vitamin E, polyphenols, Vitamin A, carotenoids (beta-carotene), Vitamin B, Vitamin C, tocopherols, alpha-lipoic acid, coenzyme Q10 CoQlO), grape seed extract, green tea, lutein, N-acetyl Cysteine (NAC), OPCs
(pycnogenols), selenium, zinc, 2,6-di-tert-para-benzoquinone, abscisic acid, bioflavonoids, DMAE (N,N-Dimethylethanolamine, precursor of choline), metronidazole, 2-methyl-5- nitroimidazole, glyoxal, polymerized 2,2,4-trimethyl- l,2-dihydroquinoline, 2- mercaptobenzimidazol, 5-tert-butyl-4-hydroxy-2-methyl-phenyl sulfide (CAS RN 96-69-5), 4- tert-butylphenol (CAS RN 98-54-4), catechol (CAS RN 120-80-9), 2-naphthol (2- hydroxynaphthalene) (CAS RN 135-19-3), octadecyl-3-(3',5'-di-tert-butyl-4- hydroxyphenyl)propionate (CAS RN 2082-79-3), l,3,5-trimethyl-2,4,6-tris(3,5-di-tert-butyl-4- hydroxybenzyl)benzene (CAS RN 1709-70-2), and tris-(2,4,-di-tert-butylphenyl)phosphite (CAS RN 31570-04-4).
[00197] In some embodiments, hindered phenol antioxidants are preferred. Examples of hindered phenol antioxidants include: 2,6-di-tert-butyl-p-cresol (BHT) (CAS RN 128-37-0), 2(3)-tert-butyl-4-hydroxyanisole (BHA), isobutylenated methylstyrenated phenol (CAS RN 68457-74-9), styrenated phenol (CAS RN 61788-44-1), 2,6-di-tert-butyl-4- (octadecanoxycarbonylethyl)phenol (CAS RN 2082-79-3), 4,4'-thiobis-6-(t-butyl-m-cresol)
(CAS RN 96-69-5), 4,4'-butylidenebis(6-t-butyl-m-cresol) (CAS RN 85-60-9), 4,4'-(l- methylethylidene)bis[2-(l,l-dimethylethyl)]phenol (CAS RN 79-96-9), 2,2'-methylenebis(4- methyl-6-nonyl)phenol (CAS RN 7786-17-6), 4-methyl-phenol reaction products with dicyclopentadiene and isobutylene (CAS RN 68610-51-5), tetrakis-(methylene-(3,5-di-tertbutyl- 4-hydrocinnamate)methane (CAS RN 6683-19-8), tert-butylhydroxyquinone (TBHQ), Irganox 1076, Ethanox 330, and l,3,5-tris(3,5-di-tert-butyl-4-hydroxybenzyl-)-l,3,5-triazine- 2,4,6(lH,3H,5H)-trione (CAS RN 27676-62-6).
[00198] Preservatives which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all of the substances which can be employed for such purposes in agrochemical compositions. Examples include dichlorophen and benzyl alcohol hemiformal.
[00199] Secondary thickeners which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all substances which can be used for such purposes in agrochemical compositions. Those contemplated with preference include cellulose derivatives, acrylic acid derivatives, xanthan, modified clays and highly disperse silica.
[00200] Stickers which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include all customary binders which can be used in seed dressing products. Preferred mention may be made of polyvinylpyrrolidone, polyvinyl acetate, polyvinyl alcohol, styrene acrylic emulsion polymers, polyethylene wax, and tylose.
[00201] Gibberellins which may be present in the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention include preferably the gibberellins Al, A3 (=gibberellic acid), A4 and A7, with gibberellic acid being used with particular preference. The gibberellins are known (cf. R. Wegler,“Chemie der Pflanzenschutz-und Schadlingsbekampfungsmittel”, Volume 2, Springer Verlag, 1970, pp. 401-412).
[00202] The seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention may be used, either directly or after prior dilution with water, to treat seed of any of a wide variety of types. Accordingly, the concentrates or the preparations obtainable from them by dilution with water may be employed to dress the seed of cereals, such as wheat, barley, rye, oats and triticale, and also the seed of maize, rice, oilseed rape, peas, beans, cotton, sunflowers and beets, or else the seed of any of a very wide variety of vegetables. The seed-dressing
formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention, or their diluted preparations, may also be used to dress seed of transgenic plants. In that case, additional synergistic effects may occur in interaction with the substances formed through expression.
[00203] For the treatment of seed with the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention, or with the preparations produced from them by addition of water, suitable mixing equipment includes all such equipment which can typically be employed for seed dressing. More particularly, the procedure when carrying out seed dressing is to place the seed in a mixer, to add the particular desired amount of seed-dressing formulations, either as such or following dilution with water beforehand, and to carry out mixing until the distribution of the formulation on the seed is uniform. This may be followed by a drying operation.
[00204] The application rate of the seed-dressing formulations which can be used in accordance with the invention may be varied within a relatively wide range. It is guided by the particular amount of the at least one biological control agent and the at least one oxaborole in the formulations, and by the seed. The application rates in the case of the composition are situated generally at between 0.001 and 50 g per kilogram of seed, preferably between 0.01 and 15 g per kilogram of seed.
[00205] The invention also relates to a method for controlling unwanted microorganisms, characterized in that the inventive composition is applied to the phytopathogenic fungi, phytopathogenic bacteria, and/or their habitat.
[00206] The formulations, according to the invention, can be used to treat all plants, plant propagation material, and plant parts. Plants means all plants and plant populations, such as desirable and undesirable wild plants, cultivars and plant varieties (whether or not protectable by plant variety or plant breeder's rights). Cultivars and plant varieties can be plants obtained by conventional propagation and breeding methods which can be assisted or supplemented by one or more biotechnological methods such as by use of double haploids, protoplast fusion, random and directed mutagenesis, molecular or genetic markers or by bioengineering and genetic engineering methods. By plant parts is meant all above ground and below ground parts and organs of plants such as shoot, leaf, blossom and root, whereby for example leaves, needles, stems, branches, blossoms, fruiting bodies, fruits and seed as well as roots, corms and rhizomes are listed. Crops and vegetative and generative propagating material, for example cuttings, corms, rhizomes, runners and seeds also belong to plant parts.
[00207] The inventive formulations, when it is well tolerated by plants, have favorable toxicity and are well tolerated by the environment, are suitable for protecting plants and plant organs, enhances harvest yields and improves the quality of the harvested material. It can preferably be used as crop protection composition. It is active against normally sensitive and tolerant species and against all or some stages of development.
[00208] While this specification contains many specific implementation details, these should not be construed as limitations on the scope of any invention or on the scope of what may be claimed, but rather as descriptions of features that may be specific to particular
implementations of particular inventions. Certain features that are described in this specification in the context of separate implementations can also be implemented in combination in a single implementation. Conversely, various features that are described in the context of a single implementation can also be implemented in multiple implementations separately or in any suitable sub-combination. Moreover, although features may be described above as acting in certain combinations and even initially claimed as such, one or more features from a claimed combination can in some cases be excised from the combination, and the claimed combination may be directed to a sub-combination or variation of a sub-combinations.
[00209] Particular implementations of the subject matter have been described. Other implementations, alterations, and permutations of the described implementations are within the scope of the following claims as will be apparent to those skilled in the art. For example, the actions recited in the claims can be performed in a different order and still achieve desirable results.
[00210] Accordingly, the above description of example implementations does not define or constrain this disclosure. Other changes, substitutions, and alterations are also possible without departing from the spirit and scope of this disclosure.
[00211] A number of embodiments of the present disclosure have been described. While this specification contains many specific implementation details, the specific implementation details should not be construed as limitations on the scope of any disclosures or of what may be claimed, but rather as descriptions of features specific to particular embodiments of the present disclosure.
[00212] Certain features that are described in this specification in the context of separate embodiments can also be implemented in combination in a single embodiment. Conversely, various features that are described in the context of a single embodiment can also be implemented in combination in multiple embodiments separately or in any suitable sub combination. Moreover, although features may be described above as acting in certain combinations and even initially claimed as such, one or more features from a claimed combination can in some cases be excised from the combination, and the claimed combination may be directed to a sub-combination or variation of a sub-combination.
[00213] In certain implementations, multitasking and parallel processing may be advantageous. Nevertheless, it will be understood that various modifications may be made without departing from the spirit and scope of the claimed disclosure.
EXAMPLES
[00214] Throughout the examples, 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol may be referred to as“BAG8”. The structure for 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol (BAG8) is:
Figure imgf000075_0001
Section I: Exemplary Benzoxaborole Formulations Example 1: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00215] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by preparing a mixture containing
9.0 mg of octylphenol polyethylene glycol ether (Triton X-45, surfactant), 9.0 mg of sodium dodecylbenzenesulfonate, 12 mg of polyethylene glycol 40 castor oil hydrogenated, 90 mg of cyclohexanone, 150 mg of xylenes, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol to obtain the emulsion concentrate. The emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and during this time the initial white emulsion quickly formed a white precipitate and clear solution. Given the instability of the diluted (applied) formulation, the mixture was not subjected to particle size analysis.
Example 2: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00216] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by first preparing a mixture containing 9.0 mg of octylphenol polyethylene glycol ether (Triton X-45), 18.0 mg of sodium dodecylbenzenesulfonate, 12 mg of polyethylene glycol 40 castor oil hydrogenated, 90 mg of cyclohexanone, 150 mg of xylenes, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol. The emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and during this time the initial white emulsion quickly formed a white precipitate and clear solution. When sieved, large chunks of material were trapped on each sieve, indicating a particle size greater than 297 pm.
Example 3: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00217] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of benzyl alcohol, 0.2 g of isophorone, 0.2 g of xylenes, 80 mg of Tween 20, and 30 mg of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and then sieved successively through #50, #100, and #325 sieves to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 20 minutes and passed through each sieve, indicating a stable formulation with a particle size of less than 44 mih.
Example 4: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00218] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of isophorone, 0.4 g of xylenes, 80 mg of Tween 20, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 20 minutes, and then sieved successively through #50, #100, and #325 sieves to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 20 minutes. When sieved, material was trapped on each sieve, indicating a particle size greater than 297 pm. Compared to Example 3, this emulsion had much larger particle size, indicating that incorporation of the protic solvent (benzyl alcohol) resulted in a smaller particle size for the emulsion.
Example 5: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00219] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of isophorone, 80 mg of Tween 20, and 30 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the emulsion showed a D50 of 111 pm and a D90 of 146 pm.
Example 6: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00220] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 1.6 g of n-butanol, 0.8 g chlorobenzene, 0.32 g of Tween 20, 0.16 g of Span 20, 0.14 g of ATLOX 4838, and 0.12 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 80 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the emulsion showed a D50 of 1.31 pm and a D90 of 4.36 pm.
Example 7: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00221] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of benzyl alcohol,
0.4 g isophorone, 0.4 g of xylenes, 0.16 g of polyethylene glycol 40 castor oil hydrogenated, 0.12 g of Span 20, 68 mg of ATLOX 4838, and 60 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 40 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the emulsion showed a D50 of 0.578 pm and a D90 of 3.78 pm.
Example 8: Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00222] A sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 40 mg of xanthan gum, 20 mg of anti-microbial, 74.09 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. 150 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a white suspension over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the solution showed a D50 of 10.70 pm and a D90 of 25.50 pm.
Example 9: Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Formulation Stability [00223] A sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 40 mg of xanthan gum, 20 mg of anti-microbial, 74.09 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. The formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 10 days at; 5°C, 20°C, and 50°C, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. Visually, the 50°C sample demonstrated hard sedimentation and settling of active ingredient but there was little to no change at the other temperature conditions. When analyzed, the applied formulation showed particle sizes illustrated by the table below.
Figure imgf000079_0001
Example 10: Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00224] A sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.24 g of xanthan gum, 0.12 g of anti-microbial, 73.79 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. 150 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a white suspension over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the suspension showed a D50 of 6.10 pm and a D90 of 15.50 pm.
Example 11: Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Formulation Stability [00225] A sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.4 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.4 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 40 mg of xanthan gum, 20 mg of anti-microbial, 73.79 g of water, and 20 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. The formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 10 days at; 5°C, 20°C, and 50°C, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. Visually, the sample displayed little to no change over the 10 days at the three temperature conditions. When analyzed, the diluted formulation showed particle sizes illustrated by Table 1 below.
Table 1.
Figure imgf000080_0001
Example 12: Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00226] A sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. 150 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 20 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a white suspension over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the solution showed a D50 of 4.57 pm and a D90 of 16.1 pm.
Example 13: Suspension Concentrate Formulation and Formulation Stability [00227] A sample suspension concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. The formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 10 days at; 5°C, 20°C, and 50°C, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. Visually, the sample displayed little to no change over the 10 days at the three temperature conditions. When analyzed, the applied formulation showed particle sizes illustrated by Table 2 below.
Table 2.
Figure imgf000081_0001
Example 14: Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied
Germination
[00228] A sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. 23 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 90%, comparable to the control which had a germination rate of 98%. Table 3.
Figure imgf000082_0002
Example 15: Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied Germination
[00229] A sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. 46 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 95%, similar to the control, which had a germination rate of 98%.
Table 4.
Figure imgf000082_0001
Example 16: Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied Germination
[00230] A sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. 70 mg of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 95%, which is similar to the germination rate of the control (98%).
Table 5.
Figure imgf000083_0001
Example 17: Suspension Concentrate for Seed Treatment Formulation and Applied Germination
[00231] A sample suspension concentrate for seed treatment was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of Atlas G-5002L, 0.8 g ATLOX 4913, 5 g of glycerin, 50 mg of anti-foam compound, 0.178 g of xanthan gum, 89 mg of anti-microbial, 53.08 g of water, and 40 g of 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(37 )-ol. 0.14 g of this suspension concentrate was then added to 0.26 g of water, 78 mg of Florite 1706, 36 mg of colorant, and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for treating seeds). The formulation was added to 100 g of soybean seeds in a tumbler seed treater. The treated seeds were planted in small pots of soil to test germination. Germination results were recorded after 7 days; as illustrated below, the treated seeds germinated at a rate of 95% which was similar to the germination rate of the control (98%).
Table 6.
Figure imgf000084_0001
Figure imgf000084_0002
Example 18: Wettable Power Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00232] A sample wettable powder was prepared by jet milling 5- chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3 )-ol (30%), Kaolin (60%), Morwet D-425 (8%), and Morwet EFW (2%) . 0.50 g of the wettable powder formulation was added to 50 mL of water in a graduated cylinder and the resulting suspension was visually monitored over the course of 5 days. While the applied formulation slowly settled over the course of 24 hours, the particulate the bottom of the graduated cylinder easily resuspended upon mixing. When analyzed, the applied formulation showed a D50 of 2.93 pm and a D90 of 6.97 pm.
Example 19: Emulsion Concentrate Formulation and Applied Formulation Stability
[00233] A sample emulsion concentrate was prepared by mixing 0.8 g of benzyl alcohol, 0.4 g isophorone, 0.4 g of xylenes, 0.16 g of polyethylene glycol 40 castor oil hydrogenated, 28 mg of ATLOX 4838, and 42 mg of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3/ )-ol. This emulsion concentrate was then added to 40 g of water and gently shaken (to produce a sample applied formulation suitable for biological testing). The applied formulation was visually monitored for stability over the course of 30 minutes, and then analyzed with a Malvern 3000E to determine particle size. The applied formulation remained a milky white emulsion over the course of 30 minutes. When analyzed, the emulsion showed a D50 of 6.70 pm and a D90 of 15.4 pm.
Example 20: BAG8 Emulsion Concentrate (EC) Formulations
[00234] In addition to the examples above, further BAG8 emulsion concentrates were prepared. The formulations were prepared by mixing the components shown in Table 7. All components in the table are provided as % w/w (percent by weight-the percentage weight of each substance of the total EC weight).
[00235] The testing results for the emulsion concentrates disclosed in Table 7 are given in Table 8. Emulsion stability was tested for each EC by aliquoting 0.628 g of emulsion concentrate into 40 mL of water, the mixture was shaken rapidly to form an emulsion, and the emulsion was allowed to sit at room temperature undisturbed for 30 minutes. Visual appearance notes were taken and then particle size was measured using a Malvern Mastersizer 3000E.
[00236] To achieve a stable emulsion with a favorable D90 particle size, a suitable combination of protic and aprotic solvents is needed. The results in Table 8 show that when using only protic solvents or aprotic solvents (i.e., using only one type of solvent rather than both types) a stable emulsion did not form, and large amounts of sedimentation were observed after a short period of time.
[00237] Moreover, the testing results indicate that surfactant selection is also important, and should be carefully considered after selecting a solvent blend. A blend of high HLB, low HLB, and anionic surfactants usually yielded the most stable emulsions with the lowest D90 particle sizes. Additionally, when the protic alcohol was removed from the top performing emulsion concentrates, the emulsions made thereafter were unstable and showed rapid sedimentation. Accordingly, it seemed that the presence of the protic component contributed to the overall stability and performance of the emulsion.
[00238] It can also be seen from the tables that the EC formulations had ratios of 15: 1 through 1:4 (ratio of protic: aprotic solvents) (i.e. 15 through 0.25). Formulations with a ratio of 1:3 had on average the lower D90 particle size. As shown in other examples, disease control was best achieved with EC formulations when the ratio was a 1:1 or 1:3 (i.e 1 or 0.33). Table 7. EC Formulations of BAG8 (Note: NMP stands for N-methyl-2-pyrrolidone)
O
O
0 O s0
00
n H bn oo o 0
0 s0
Figure imgf000086_0001
Figure imgf000087_0001
o
O
O
0 s©0
00
n
H
bno o o
0
0 s©0
Figure imgf000088_0001
Table 8. Emulsion Stability of BAG8 Emulsion Concentrates Disclosed in Table 7
Figure imgf000089_0001
Figure imgf000090_0001
Figure imgf000091_0001
Example 21: SC and EC Formulation Stability
[00239] BAG8 formulation samples were stored at 5°C, 20°C, or 50°C, and the stability of the samples was determined by visual appearance at time points of 0 days and 10 days. The particle size was also determined for each sample following dilution into water at each time point using a particle size analyzer (Malvern 3000E). D90 particle size values were recorded for each sample and each time point. The pH of each sample was also recorded for each temperature at day zero and day 10.
[00240] It is desirable for the pH of the diluted/applied formulation to remain the same or to change minimally when the formulation is stored at various temperatures. It is also desirable for the D90 of the diluted/applied formulation to remain the same or to change minimally when the formulation is stored at various temperatures As can be seen below, the pH remained the same or similar for many exemplary formulations at day 0 and at day 14 (compared to the 20 °C sample at day zero). Generally, the pH of the applied/diluted formulation may influence whether the benzoxaborole (BAG8) is in its neutral, planar form, or its ionic, tetrahedral form.
Table 9.
Figure imgf000091_0002
Figure imgf000092_0001
Table 10.
Figure imgf000092_0002
Figure imgf000093_0001
Example 22: BAG8-Alcohol Adduct Studies
[00241] A stock solution of 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3//)-ol was prepared in DMSO-de and the resulting solution was aliquoted into 5 NMR tubes (Samples 1-5 in Table 11 below). For purposes of the formulation example section, 5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3//)-ol will be referred to as BAG8. The amount of n-butanol indicated in Table 11 was then added to samples 1-5. An additional sample of n-butanol in DMSO-dr, was also prepared for reference purposes (Sample No. 6).
[00242] 'H-NMR spectra were then recorded for each sample. Peaks corresponding to a BAG8 and n-butanol adduct were noted between S 7.5 - 7.7 ppm and at S 5.07 ppm with increasing intensity as the relative concentration of n-butanol increased, indicating the presence of a BAG8 and n-butanol adduct and BAG8 mixture (see Scheme 4 below). The ratio of the BAG8 and n- butanol adduct to BAG8 was determined by integration for each sample. The results are shown below in Table 11. An overlay of the 'H-NMR spectra are shown in FIG. 1. The numbers displayed on the spectra in FIG. 1 correspond to the Sample No. in Table 11.
Table 11.
Figure imgf000093_0002
Figure imgf000094_0001
Scheme 4.
Example 23: BAG8 Suspension Concentrate (SC) -Adjuvant Compatibility Studies
[00243] The 20% BAG8 SC and 40% BAG8 SC described in Example 10 and Example 12, respectively, were tested for compatibility with various tank-mix adjuvants.
[00244] The amount of SC used for all tests was calculated such that there was 30 mg of BAG8 in each test. The adjuvants were tank-mixed with BAG8 SC at the label rate, using the mixing instructions indicated on the label. Each test used 20 mL of water.
[00245] The visual appearance of each of the tank-mixes was noted at zero minutes, 30 minutes, and 24 hours. Particle size analysis was done 30 minutes and 24 hours after initial mixing for tank- mixes that were visually stable for 30 minutes (Malvern 3000E).
[00246] For the Silwet Stik 2 tests, the BAG8 SC was added to water, then the Silwet Stik 2 was added to the resulting BAG8 mixture. Using the opposite order of addition (Silwet Stik 2 to water, followed by BAG8 SC) resulted in the formation of a white sediment that was not suitable for further analysis or use.
[00247] The results of the tests are shown in Table 12. The mixtures deemed compatible did not form sediments or oil slicks, and had similar particle size values at 30 minutes and 24 hours. The results show that the BAG8 SC formulations tested are compatible with a wide array of tank mix adjuvants. Table 12.
O
O
O
00
00
n H bno o o
0
00
Figure imgf000095_0001
o
O
O
00
00
n H
Figure imgf000096_0001
bno o o
0
00
Example 24: BAG8 SC Biological Efficacy Studies
[00248] The BAG8 SC formulations described in Example 10 (BAG8 20% SC) and Example 12 (BAG8 40% SC) and selected BAG8 SC-tank mix formulations described in Example 23 were tested under greenhouse conditions. Data was obtained for soybean/white mold ( Sclerotinia sclerotiorum ), wheat/septoria ( Mycosphaerella graminicola), and watermelon/downy mildew. For each experiment, the BAG8 was applied at a rate of 0.25 lb/acre and at a spray rate of 20 gal/acre.
[00249] For this Example, the BAG8 EC used was: 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX 4838B
(percentages are by weight).
[00250] The results show that all tested SC formulations of BAG8 had
significantly lower disease severity compared to the untreated control. Specifically, the BAG8 20% SC tank mixed with Silwet Stik 2 and BAG8 40% SC tank-mixed with Aircover provided significantly better disease control compared to the untreated and most other formulations for all three pathosystems.
Table 13: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 SC Formulations on Wheat Septoria
Figure imgf000097_0001
Figure imgf000098_0003
*Means followed by the same letter are not significantly different from each other
(a=0.05).
Table 14: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 SC Formulations on Soybean White Mold
Figure imgf000098_0001
*Means fol owed by the same letter are not significantly c ifferent from each other
(a=0.05).
Table 15: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 SC Formulations on Watermelon/Downy
Mildew.
Figure imgf000098_0002
Figure imgf000099_0001
* Means followed by the same letter are not significantly different from each other (a=0.05).
Example 25: SC, WP, and EC Biological Efficacy Studies
[00251] Various BAG8 EC formulations, the BAG8 WP formulation described in Example 18, and selected BAG8 SC-tank mix formulations described in Example 23 were tested under greenhouse conditions. Data was obtained for soybean/white mold ( Sclerotinia sclerotiorum ), wheat/septoria ( Mycosphaerella graminicola), and
cucumber/downy mildew. For each experiment, the BAG8 was applied at a rate of 0.25 lb/acre at a spray rate of 20 gal/acre (40 mL of spray solution prepared). All inoculum was applied 24 hours post BAG8 spray.
[00252] Unformulated BAG8 was applied to the plants by dissolving BAG8 in a 30% acetone-70% water solution.
[00253] The percentages shown for BAG8 EC are in weight percent.
[00254] The results for this study are found in Examples 26-29.
[00255] The treatments used, crop, disease and results are shown below in Tables 16-20 (for Examples 26-29). Means followed by the same letter are not significantly different from each other (a=0.05).
[00256] The results show that, in many instances, the plants treated with unformulated BAG8 did not have lower disease severity than an untreated control. Thus, the results indicate that formulated BAG8 is more effective than unformulated BAG8. In fact, the level of efficacy for unformulated BAG8 falls below the industry standard for commercial formulation development. [00257] Contrastingly, the results show that plants treated with a BAG8 SC, BAG8 EC, or BAG8 WP are more healthy than untreated plants in all cases and in most instances the plants are also more healthy than those treated with unformulated BAG8.
Example 26.:
[00258] The BAG8 EC formulations used for this example are shown below Table 16. The protocol described in Example 25 was used for this assay.
Table 16: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 Formulations on Wheat Septoria
Figure imgf000100_0001
BAG8 EC 1: 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX
4838B
BAG8 EC 2: 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 22, 1.6% ATLOX 4916, 9.6%
BAG8
BAG8 EC 3: 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 22, 1.6% Span 20, 9.6% BAG8 BAG8 EC 4: 57.3% decyl alcohol, 19.1% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 20, 1.6% ATLOX 4916, 9.6%
BAG8
Example 27.:
[00259] The BAG8 EC formulations used for this example are shown below Table 17. The protocol described in Example 25 was used for this assay.
Table 17: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 Formulations on Cucumber/Downy Mildew.
Figure imgf000101_0001
BAG8 EC 1: 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX
4838B
BAG8 EC 2: 38.2% isophorone, 19.1% decyl alcohol, 19.1% xylenes, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% BAG8, 9.6% Tween 60 BAG8 EC 3: 9.5% isophorone, 66.7% decyl alcohol, 4.4%
ATLOX 4838B, 9.8% BAG8, 9.5% Tween 20.
BAG8 EC 4: 57.3% decyl alcohol, 19.1% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 20, 1.6% ATLOX 4916, 9.6%
BAG8
BAG8 EC 5: 38.2% isophorone, 19.1% decyl alcohol, 19.1% limonene, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 22, 9.6% BAG8
BAG8 EC 6: 4.8% isophorone, 71.7% decyl alcohol, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 60, 9.6% BAG8
BAG8 EC 7: 19.1% isophorone, 38.2% decyl alcohol, 19.1% limonene, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 85, 9.6% BAG8
BAG8 EC 8: 19.1% isophorone, 38.2% decyl alcohol, 19.1% xylenes, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 60, 9.6% BAG8
Example 28.:
[00260] The BAG8 EC formulations used for this example are shown below Table 18. The protocol described in Example 25 was used for this assay.
Table 18: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 Formulations on Cucumber/Downy Mildew.
Figure imgf000102_0001
BAG8 EC 1: 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6% isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX
4838B
BAG8 EC 2: 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 22, 1.6% ATLOX 4916, 9.6%
BAG8
BAG8 EC 3: 19.1% decyl alcohol, 57.3% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 22, 1.6% Span 20, 9.6% BAG8
BAG8 EC 4: 57.3% decyl alcohol, 19.1% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 20, 1.6% ATLOX 4916, 9.6%
BAG8
Example 29. :
[00261] The BAG8 EC formulations used for this example are shown below Table 19. The protocol described in Example 25 was used for this assay.
Table 19: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 Formulations on Soybean/White Mold.
Figure imgf000103_0001
Table 20: Biological Efficacy of BAG8 Formulations on Cucumber/Downy Mildew.
Figure imgf000104_0001
BAG8 EC 1: 3.4% BAG8, 43.2% benzyl alcohol, 21.6%
isophorone, 21.6% xylenes, 8.6% PEG 40, 1.5% ATLOX
4838B
BAG8 EC 2: 38.2% isophorone, 19.1% decyl alcohol, 19.1%
xylenes, 4.5% ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 60, 9.6% BAG8
BAG8 EC 3: 9.6% isophorone, 66.9% decyl alcohol, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 9.6% Tween 20, 9.6% BAG8
BAG8 EC 4: 57.3% decyl alcohol, 19.1% isophorone, 4.5%
ATLOX 4838B, 8.0% Tween 20, 1.6% ATLOX 4916, 9.6%
BAG8
Section II: Experimental Procedures for Syntheses of Exemplary Benzoxaborole
Compounds
[00262] FIG. 2 contains a table that provides chemical characterization data for a number of exemplary benzoxaborole compounds, including some of those for which synthesis is described in the examples below. FIG. 2 contains chemical structure, formula, IUPAC chemical name, MS, and HPLC purity data for each compound.
Example 1: 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-N,N-dimethyl-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine
Figure imgf000105_0001
[00263] To a mixture of 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (0.2 g, 918.08 umol, 1 eq) in MeOH (5 mL) was added acetic acid (82.70 mg, 1.38 mmol, 78.76 uL, 1.5 eq) and formaldehyde solution (74.51 mg, 918.08 umol, 37% W/W, 1 eq) at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 1 h, then NaBH3CN (86.54 mg, 1.38 mmol, 1.5 eq) was added to the mixture at 0°C, and the resulting mixture was stirred at 20°C for 11 h. The reaction mixture was quenched by addition of saturated aqueous NH4CI solution (10 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 35%-65%, 10 min) to give 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-N,N-dimethyl-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol- 6-amine (40 mg, 162.67 umol, 17.72% yield) as a white solid.1H NMR (DMSO-<i6, 400 MHz) d 9.24 (s, 1H), 7.48 (s, 1H), 4.92 (s, 2H), 2.82 (s, 6H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C9HnBCl3N02 280.00, m/z found 246.0 [M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 86.26% (220 nm), 94.3% (254 nm).
Example 2: 5,7-dichloro-N,N-diethyl-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine
Figure imgf000105_0002
[00264] To a mixture of 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (250 mg, 1.15 mmol, 1 eq ) in MeOH (5 mL) was added dropwise acetaldehyde (126.39 mg, 1.15 mmol, 161.00 uL, 40% purity, 1 eq) and CH3COOH (103.37 mg, 1.72 mmol, 98.45 uL, 1.5 eq) at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 1 h, and then NaBH3CN (108.18 mg, 1.72 mmol, 1.5 eq) was added. The resulting mixture was stirred at 20°C for 11 h, then quenched by addition of saturated aqueous NH4CI solution (10 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 45%-70%, 10 min) to give 5,7- dichloro-N,N-diethyl-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol -6-amine (40 mg, 146.01 umol, 12.72% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-r/e, 400 MHz) d 7.50 (s, 1H), 4.94 (s, 2H), 3.19-3.13 (m, 4H), 0.93 (t, / = 7.2 Hz, 6H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For
C11H14BCI2NO2 273.05, m/z found 274.0 [M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 100.00% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm).
Example 3: 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-N-methyl-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine
Figure imgf000106_0001
tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl) -N-methyl- carbamate
[00265] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (0.2 g, 629.01 umol, 1 eq ) in DMF (2 mL) was added NaH (75.47 mg, 1.89 mmol, 60% purity, 3 eq) in portions at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, and then Mel (89.28 mg, 629.01 umol, 39.16 uL, 1 eq) was added to the mixture at 0°C, and the resutling mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h. The reaction mixture was quenched by addition saturated aqueous NH4Cl solution (10 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro
Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water(0. l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 35%-65%, 10 min) to give tert-butyl N-(5,7- dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)-N- methyl-carbamate (130 mg, 391.58 umol, 62.25% yield) as a white solid. ' H NMR (DMSO- e, 400 MHz) d 9.36 (m, 1H), 7.64 (s, 1H), 5.05-4.94 (m, 2H), 3.04-3.00 (m, 3H), 1.47-1.26 (m, 9H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C13H16BCI2NO4 331.05, m/z found 276.0 [M-56+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 99.18% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm). [00266] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl) -N-methyl-carbamate (0.1 g, 301.22 umol, 1 eq ) in EtOAc (5 mL) was added a solution of HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 753.04 uL, 10 eq) at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 1 h, then concentrated under reduced pressure to give 5,7-dichloro-l- hydroxy-N-methyl -3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (71 mg, 264.60 umol, 87.84% yield, HC1) as a yellow solid.1H NMR (DMSO-<fc, 400 MHz) d 7.41 (s, 1H), 4.88 (s, 2H), 2.88 (s, 3H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For CgHgBCbNOi 266.98, m/z found 231.9 [M+H]+.
Purity by HPLC: 100.00% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm).
Example 4: 5,7-dichloro-N-ethyl-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine
Figure imgf000107_0001
tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl) -N-ethyl-carbamate
[00267] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (0.2 g, 629.01 umol, 1 eq) in DMF (3 mL) was added NaH (75.47 mg, 1.89 mmol, 60% purity, 3 eq) in portions at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, then CH3CH2I (117.72 mg, 754.81 umol, 60.37 uL, 1.2 eq) was added.
The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, then quenched by addition of saturated aqueous NH4CI solution (10 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column:
Xtimate C18 l50*25mm*5um; mobile phase: [water(0.04%NH3H2O+l0mM NH4HCO3)- ACN]; B%: 22%-52%,l0.5min) to give tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)-N-ethyl-carbamate (100 mg, 289.01 umol, 45.95% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-<fc, 400 MHz) d 9.30 (s, 1H), 7.63 (s, 1H), 5.04-4.94 (m, 2H), 3.58-3.46 (m, 2H), 1.46-1.26 (m, 9H), 1.11-1.01 (m, 3H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For Ci4Hi8BCl2N04 345.07, m/z found 290.0 [M-56+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 99.83% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm). [00268] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl) -N-ethyl-carbamate (100 mg, 289.01 umol, 1 eq) in EtOAc (5 mL) was added a solution of HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 1.45 mL, 20 eq) at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 1 h, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to give 5,7- dichloro-N-ethyl-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (65 mg, crude, HC1) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-r/e, 400 MHz) d 7.43 (s, 1H), 4.89 (s, 2H), 3.25 (q, / = 7.2 Hz, 2H), 1.07 (t, / = 7.2 Hz, 3H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C9H11BCI3NO2 280.99, m/z found 246.0 [M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 98.92% (220 nm), 99.32% (254 nm).
Example 5: 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-N-propyl-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine
Figure imgf000108_0001
tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol -6-yl)-N-propyl- carbamate
[00269] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (200 mg, 629.01 umol, 1 eq ) in DMF (4 mL) was added NaH (75.48 mg, 1.89 mmol, 60% purity, 3 eq) in portions at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, and then l-iodopropane (160.39 mg, 943.51 umol, 92.18 uL, 1.5 eq) was added at 0°C. The resulting mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, then quenched by addition of saturated aqueous NH4Cl solution (10 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase:
[water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 50%-75%, 10 min). Compound tert-butyl N-(5, 7- dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)-N-propyl-carbamate (110 mg, 305.52 umol, 48.57% yield) was obtained as a white solid. 'H NMR (DMSO-r/r,, 400 MHz) d 9.33 (s, 1H), 7.63 (s, 1H), 5.05-4.95 (m, 2H), 3.45-3.36 (m, 2H), 1.53-1.26 (m, 11H), 0.87-0.81 (m, 3H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C15H20BCI2NO4 359.09, m/z found 304.0 [M-56+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 97.9% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm). [00270] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl) -N-propyl-carbamate (80 mg, 222.20 umol, 1 eq) in EtOAc (5 mL) was added HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 1.11 mL, 20 eq) at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 1 h. The reaction mixture concentrated under reduced pressure to give 5,7-dichloro- l-hydroxy -N-propyl-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (51 mg, 172.07 umol, 77.44% yield, HC1) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-r/e, 400 MHz) d 7.42 (s, 1H), 4.89 (s, 2H), 3.24- 3.18 (m, 2H), 1.53-1.44 (m, 2H), 0.87 (t, / = 7.2 Hz, 3H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C10H13BCI3NO2 295.01, m/z found 260.0 [M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 97.45% (220 nm), 95.61% (254 nm).
Example 6: N-butyl-5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine
Figure imgf000109_0001
tert-butyl N-butyl-N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol -6-yl)carbamate
[00271] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro- l-hydroxy-3H-2, 1- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (200 mg, 629.01 umol, 1 eq ) in DMF (4 mL) was added NaH (75.48 mg, 1.89 mmol, 60% purity, 3 eq) in portions at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, then l-iodobutane (173.63 mg, 943.51 umol, 107.18 uL, 1.5 eq) was added at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, then quenched by addition of saturated aqueous NH4Cl solution (10 mL), extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)- ACN]; B%: 55%-80%, 10 min) to give tert-butyl N-butyl-N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H- 2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (120 mg, 320.80 umol, 51.00% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO- , 400 MHz) d 9.32 (s, 1H), 7.62 (s, 1H), 5.04-4.94 (m, 2H), 3.48-3.41 (m, 2H), 1.49-1.22 (m, 13H), 0.87-0.81 (m, 3H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For
C16H22BCI2NO4 373.10, m/z found 318.0 [M-56+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 98.83% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm). [00272] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-butyl-N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol -6-yl)carbamate (90 mg, 240.60 umol, 1 eq) in EtOAc (5 mL) was added HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 1.20 mL, 20 eq) at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 1 h. The reaction mixture concentrated under reduced pressure to give N-butyl-5,7-dichloro-l- hydroxy -3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (57 mg, crude, HC1) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO -de, 400 MHz) d 7.42 (s, 1H), 4.88 (s, 2H), 3.23 (t, J = 7.2 Hz, 2H), 1.49-1.41 (m, 2H), 1.34-1.28 (m, 2H), 0.86 (t, / = 7.2 Hz, 3H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For
C11H15BCI3NO2 309.03, m/z found 274.0 [M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 97.25% (220 nm), 94.9% (254 nm).
Example 7: 5,7-dichloro-N-(cyclobutylmethyl)-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol -6- amine
Figure imgf000110_0001
tert-butyl N-(cyclobutylmethyl)-N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l -benzoxaborol-6- yl)carbamate
[00273] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (200 mg, 629.01 umol, 1 eq ) in DMF (3 mL) was added NaH (75.47 mg, 1.89 mmol, 60% purity, 3 eq) in portions at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h, then KI (10.44 mg, 62.90 umol, 0.1 eq) and
bromomethylcyclobutane (140.61 mg, 943.51 umol, 105.72 uL, 1.5 eq) were added at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 12 h. After completion, the reaction mixture was quenched by addition of saturated aqueous NH4Cl solution (10 mL), extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 55%-85%, 10 min) to give tert-butyl N-(cyclobutylmethyl)-N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy -3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (34 mg, 88.07 umol, 14.00% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO- 6, 400 MHz) d 9.35 (s, 1H), 7.61 (s, 1H), 5.04-4.94 (m, 2H), 3.60-3.52 (m, 2H), 2.51-2.40 (m, 1H), 1.89- 1.87 (m, 2H), 1.74-1.73 (m, 2H), 1.57-1.54 (m, 2H), 1.46-1.25 (m, 9H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C17H22BCI2NO4 385.10, m/z found 330.0 [M-56+H]+. Purity by HPLC:
99.48% (220 nm), 97.18% (254 nm).
[00274] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(cyclobutylmethyl)-N-(5,7-dichloro-l- hydroxy -3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (0.18 g, 466.23 umol, 1 eq) in EtOAc (5 mL) was added HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 2.33 mL, 20 eq) at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 1 h. The reaction mixture concentrated under reduced pressure to give 5,7- dichloro-N-(cyclobutylmethyl)-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (142 mg, HC1) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO- 6, 400 MHz) d 7.41 (s, 1H), 4.88 (s, 2H), 3.26 (d, / = 7.2 Hz, 2H), 2.50-2.39 (m, 1H), 1.96-1.94 (m, 2H), 1.82-1.78 (m, 2H), 1.68-1.63 (m, 2H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C12H14BCI2NO2 285.05, m/z found 286.0 [M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 98.38% (220 nm), 97.97% (254 nm).
Example 8: 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-N-isopropyl-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine
Figure imgf000111_0001
tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)-N- isopropyl- carbamate
[00275] To a solution of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (0.3 g, 943.51 umol, 1 eq) in DMF (6 mL) was added NaH (67.93 mg, 1.70 mmol, 60% purity, 1.8 eq) at 0°C. After addition, the mixture was stirred at this temperature for 30 min, then 2-iodopropane (240.58 mg, 1.42 mmol, 141.52 uL, 1.5 eq) was added at 0°C. The resulting mixture was stirred at 0°C for 30 min. The reaction mixture was poured into saturated aqueous NH4Cl solution (20 mL) at 0°C, and stirred for 3 min. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (15 mL x 3). The combined organic phase was washed with brine (10 mL x 1), dried with anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuum. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: x-chargel50*25mm*5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 45%- 70%, 10 min) to give tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)- N-isopropyl-carbamate (0.125 g, 347.18 umol, 36.80% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-de, 400 MHz) d 9.34 (s, 1H), 7.62 (s, 1H), 5.07-4.93 (m, 2H), 4.09-3.97 (m, 1H), 1.49-1.24 (m, 9H), 1.18-1.16 (m, 6H).
[00276] To a solution of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)-N-isopropyl- carbamate (0.12 g, 333.30 umol, 1 eq) in EtOAc (10 mL) was added HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 12.40 mL, 148.82 eq). The mixture was stirred at 25°C for 2 h, and then concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: x-chargel50*25mm*5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)- ACN];B%: 35%-55%,l0min) to give 5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-N-isopropyl-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-amine (0.072 g, 277.00 umol, 83.11% yield, 100% purity) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO- 6, 400 MHz) d 7.44 (s, 1H), 4.90 (s, 2H), 3.80-3.72 (m, 1H),
1.11 (d, 7 = 6.4 Hz, 6H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C10H12BCI2NO2 259.03, m/z found 260.1 [M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 100% (220 nm), 100% (254 nm).
Example 9: 5,7-dichloro-N-(cyclopropylmethyl)-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol- 6- amine
Figure imgf000112_0001
tert-butyl N-(cyclopropylmethyl)-N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol- 6-yl)carbamate
[00277] To a solution of tert-butyl N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (0.3 g, 943.51 umol, 1 eq) in DMF (6 mL) was added NaH (71.70 mg, 1.79 mmol, 60% purity, 1.9 eq) at 0°C, and kept stirring for 30 min, then KI (15.66 mg, 94.35 umol, 0.1 eq) and bromomethylcyclopropane (191.06 mg, 1.42 mmol, 135.51 uL, 1.5 eq) were added to the reaction mixture at 0°C. The resulting mixture was stirred at 0°C for 30 min, and then poured into saturated aqueous NH4Cl solution (20 mL) at 0°C, and stirred for 3 min. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (15 mL x 3). The combined organic phase was washed with brine (10 mL x 1), dried over anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuum. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: x-chargel50*25mm*5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 50%- 65%, 10 min) to give tert-butyl N-(cyclopropylmethyl)-N-(5,7-dichloro-l-hydroxy-3H- 2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (0.095 g, 255.34 umol, 27.06% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO -d6, 400 MHz) d 9.34 (s, 1H), 7.62 (s, 1H), 5.05-4.96 (m, 2H), 3.47-3.28 (m, 2H), 1.47 (s, 3H), 1.27 (s, 6H), 0.96-0.89 (m, 1H), 0.36-0.30 (m, 2H), 0.02-0.06 (m, 2H).
[00278] To a solution of tert-butyl N-(cyclopropylmethyl)-N-(5,7-dichloro-l- hydroxy-3H-2,l- benzoxaborol-6-yl)carbamate (0.095 g, 255.34 umol, 1 eq) in EtOAc (10 mL) was added HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 9.50 mL, 148.82 eq). The mixture was stirred at 25°C for 2 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure, giving a residue that was purified by prep-HPLC (column: x-chargel50*25mm*5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 35%-53%, 10 min) to give 5,7-dichloro-N- (cyclopropylmethyl)-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-amine (0.053 g, 194.90 umol, 76.33% yield, 100% purity) as a yellow solid. Ή NMR (DMSO -d6, 400 MHz) d 7.42 (s, 1H), 4.89 (s, 2H), 3.08 (d, / = 7.2 Hz, 2H), 0.96-0.93 (m, 1H), 0.41-0.37 (m, 2H), 0.17- 0.14 (m, 2H). MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C11H12BCI2NO2 271.03 m/z found 272.1
[M+H]+. Purity by HPLC: 100% (220 nm), 100% (254 nm).
Example 10: 6-amino-5,7-dichlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol
Figure imgf000113_0001
[00279] A solution of compound 6-aminobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol (1 g, 6.7 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) were added NCS (2 g, 13 mmol) at 0°C in portions, the mixture was stirred at 25°C for 2 h, LCMS indicated the reaction was completed, the reaction was quenched by ice-water (20 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mLx5) , the organic layers were washed with brine (20 mLx3), dried over anhydrous Na2S04, concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (0.1% FA in MeCN and H20) to give 6- amino-5,7-dichlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol (55 mg, 4%) as a white powder. 'H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-rfc): d 9.09 (s, 1H), 7.32 (s, 1H), 5.37 (s, 2H), 4.85 (s, 2H) ppm. HPLC purity: 99.97% at 210 nm and 99.89% at 254 nm. MS (ESI): mass calcd. For C7H6BCl2N02 217.0 m/z found 218.0 [M+H]+.
Example 11: 5-Chloro-4-(difluoromethoxy)benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol
Figure imgf000114_0001
[00280] To a solution of 4-bromo-l-chloro-2-fluorobenzene (23 g, 109.81 mmol, 1 eq) in THF (200 mL) was added LDA (2 M, 65.89 mL, 1.2 eq) at -70°C. The mixture was stirred at -70°C for 2 h, and to it was added DMF (12.04 g, 164.72 mmol, 12.67 mL, 1.5 eq). The mixture was stirred at -70°C for 1 h. Water (100 mL) and aqueous NH4Cl (100 mL) were added to the reaction mixture at 0°C. The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate (100 mL x 3). The combined organic phase was washed with brine (150 mL), dried with anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuum. The residue was purified by Combi Flash (1000 mesh silica gel, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 80/1 to 50/1) to afford 6-bromo-3-chloro-2-fluoro benzaldehyde (21 g, 88.44 mmol, 80.53% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (CDCI3, 400 MHz): d 10.32 (s, 1H), 7.51-7.44 (m, 2H) ppm. To a solution of 6-bromo-3-chloro-2-fluorobenzaldehyde (19 g, 80.02 mmol, 1 eq) in DMSO (200 mL) was added a solution of KOH (4.49 g, 80.02 mmol, 1 eq) in H20 (5 mL) at 25°C. The mixture was stirred at 60°C for 15 h. Then more KOH (4.49 g, 80.02 mmol, 1 eq) in water (5 mL) was added to the mixture at 25°C. The mixture was stirred at 60°C for one more hour. The residue was poured into ice-water (w/w = 1/1, 150 mL) and was adjusted to pH 5 by 2N HC1 acid. The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate (150 mL x 3). The combined organic phase was washed with water (100 mL) and brine (100 mL), dried with anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuum. The residue was purified by combi flash (1000 mesh silica gel, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 5/1 to 2/1) to afford 6-bromo-3-chloro-2- hydroxybenzaldehyde (10 g, 42.47 mmol, 53.1% yield) as a yellow solid. 'H NMR (CDCL, 400 MHz): d 12.53 (s, 1H), 10.31 (s, 1H), 7.45 (d, / = 8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (d, / = 8.4 Hz, 1H) ppm. To a mixture of 6-bromo-3-chloro-2-hydroxybenzaldehyde (9 g, 38.22 mmol, 1 eq) and l-[[bromo(difluoro)methyl]-ethoxy-phosphoryl]oxyethane (15.31 g, 57.33 mmol, 1.5 eq) in H20 (100 mL) and MeCN (100 mL) was added a solution of KOH (21.45 g, 382.23 mmol, 10 eq) in H20 (20 mL) at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 2 h. The residue was poured into ice-water (100 mL). The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate (100 mL x 3). The combined organic phase was washed with brine (100 mL), dried with anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuum. The residue was purified by combi flash (1000 mesh silica gel, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 3/1, 1/1) to afford 6-bromo-3-chloro-2- (difluoromethoxy)benzaldehyde (4.7 g, 16.46 mmol, 43.1% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (CDCL, 400 MHz): d 10.28 (s, 1H), 7.58 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.53 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 6.69 (t, J = 74.0 Hz, 1H) ppm. To a mixture of 6-bromo-3-chloro-2-(difluoromethoxy)benzaldehyde (1 g, 3.50 mmol, 1 eq) and Pin2B2 (4.45 g, 17.51 mmol, 5 eq) in l,4-dioxane (20 mL) was added KOAc (515.68 mg, 5.25 mmol, 1.5 eq) and Pd(dppf)Cl2 (128.16 mg, 175.15 umol, 0.05 eq) in one portion at 25°C. The mixture was stirred at l20°C for 2 h under N2. The reaction mixture was filtered, and the filtrate was concentrated. The residue was purified by Combi Flash (1000 mesh silica gel, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 10/1, 3/1) to afford 3-chloro-2- (difluoro methoxy)-6-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl -l,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzaldehyde (0.5 g, 1.50 mmol, 42.9% yield) as yellow oil. 1H NMR (CDCL, 400 MHz): d 10.35 (s, 1H), 7.67 (d, 7 = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.41 (d, 7 = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 6.64 (t, 7 = 74.0 Hz, 1H), 1.43 (s, 12H) ppm. To a mixture of 3-chloro-2-(difluoromethoxy)-6-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2- dioxaborolan-2-yl) benzaldehyde (0.33 g, 992.38 umol, 1 eq) in THF (10 mL) was added NaBH4 (168.95 mg, 4.47 mmol, 4.5 eq) at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h. The residue was poured into ice-water (w/w = 1/1, 10 mL) and adjusted to pH = 5. The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate (10 mL x 3). The combined organic phase was washed with brine (10 mL), dried with anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuum. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water (0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 35%-45%, 10 min) to afford 5-chloro-4-(difluoromethoxy)benzo[c] [l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol (0.143 g, 605.70 umol, 61.0% yield, 99.28% purity) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-ί/ό, 400 MHz): 5 9.52 (s, 1H), 7.68 (d, 7 = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.61 (d, 7 = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (t, 7 = 73.2 Hz, 1H), 5.07 (s, 2H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 233.0 [M-H]\ HPLC: 99.28% (220 nm), 100% (254 nm).
Example 12: 7-Bromo-4-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol
Figure imgf000116_0001
[00281] To a solution of 5-bromo-2-chlorobenzoic acid (24.8 g, 105.32 mmol, 1 eq) in MeOH (100 mL) was added H2S04 (10.33 g, 105.32 mmol, 5.61 mL, 1 eq), and the mixture was refluxed for 3 h. It was concentrated under reduced pressure to remove most of methanol. The residue was added to cold water (300 mL) and stirred for 10 min. The mixture was filtered, and the white cake was washed with cold water (100 mL), and then dried to give methyl 5-bromo-2-chloro-benzoate (24.9 g, 99.80 mmol, 94.8% yield) as white solid. 1H NMR (CDCL, 400 MHz): 5 7.96 (d, 7 = 2.8 Hz, 1H), 7.78 (dd, 7 = 8.8,
2.8 Hz, 1H), 7.54 (d, 7 = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 3.86 (s, 3H) ppm. To a mixture of methyl 5-bromo- 2-chlorobenzoate (5 g, 20.04 mmol, 1 eq) and 2-isopropoxy-4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2- dioxaborolane (7.46 g, 40.08 mmol, 8.18 mL, 2 eq) in THF (100 mL) was added LDA (2 M, 30.06 mL, 3 eq) in one portion at -60°C under N2. The mixture was stirred at -60°C for 3 h under N2. After completion, the reaction mixture was quenched by addition of aqueous NH4Cl solution (20 mL) and extracted with EtOAc (30 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (30 mL x 3), dried over anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by column chromatography (Si02, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 1/0 to 50:1). Compound methyl 3- bromo-6-chloro-2-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (3 g, 7.99 mmol, 39.9% yield) was obtained as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-ifc, 400 MHz): d 7.75 (d, / = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.55 (d, / = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 3.86 (s, 3H), 1.31 (s, 12H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 276.9 [M-99]+. To a mixture of methyl 3-bromo-6-chloro-2-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2- dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (0.3 g, 799.04 umol, 1 eq) in THF (10 mL) and MeOH (2 mL) was added NaBH4 (60.46 mg, 1.60 mmol, 2 eq) in one portion at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 25°C for 1 h. The reaction mixture was quenched with HC1 (2N, 3mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to give a residue. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN];B%: 35%-60%, lOmin). Compound 7-bromo-4-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol (64.4 mg, 260.43 umol, 32.6% yield) was obtained as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-ifc, 400 MHz): d 9.36 (s, 1H), 7.55 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.46 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.98 (s, 2H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 244.8 & 246.8 [M-H]\ HPLC: 99.64% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm).
Example 13: 5-Chloro-7-(difluoromethoxy)benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol
Figure imgf000118_0001
Pin2B2, Pd(PPh3)2CI2
KOAc, dioxane
Figure imgf000118_0003
120°C, 5 h 0-25°C, 1.5 h
Figure imgf000118_0004
Figure imgf000118_0002
[00282] To a solution of 2-amino-3-methoxybenzoic acid (20 g, 119.64 mmol, 1 eq) in MeOH (250 mL) was added H2S04 (55.20 g, 551.56 mmol, 30 mL, 98% purity, 4.61 eq). The mixture was stirred at 90°C for 48 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure to remove MeOH. The residue was diluted with H20 (100 mL) and was added saturated aqueous NaHC03 until pH=8. The aqueous solution was extracted with EtOAc (50 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (75 mL x 2), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to give methyl 2-amino-3-methoxybenzoate (17 g, 93.83 mmol, 78.4% yield) as brown oil. 1H NMR (CDCL, 400 MHz): d 7.48 (d, / = 7.2 Hz, 1H), 6.86 (d, / = 6.8 Hz, 1H), 6.58 (t, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 6.01 (br s, 2H), 3.88 (s, 6H) ppm. To a solution of methyl 2-amino-3-methoxybenzoate (16.5 g, 91.07 mmol, 1 eq) in DMF (200 mL) was added NCS (12.53 g, 93.80 mmol, 1.03 eq) at 25°C. The resulting mixture was stirred and heated at 50°C for 2 h. The reaction mixture was quenched by addition ice-water (500 mL) at 0°C, and then extracted with EtOAc (100 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (300 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and
concentrated under reduced pressure to give methyl 2-amino-5-chloro-3- methoxybenzoate (19 g, 88.11 mmol, 96.8% yield) as brown oil, which was used into the next step without further purification. 'H NMR (CDCL, 400 MHz): d 7.46 (d, J = 2.0 Hz, 1H), 6.79 (d, J = 2.4 Hz, 1H), 6.01 (br s, 2H), 3.87 (s, 6H) ppm. To a solution of methyl 2-amino-5-chloro-3-methoxybenzoate (19 g, 88.11 mmol, 1 eq) in CH3CN (300 mL) was added CuBr2 (40 g, 179.09 mmol, 8.39 mL, 2.03 eq) resulting in a dark color. The mixture was stirred for 20 min at 25°C, and t-BuONO (16.36 g, 158.60 mmol, 18.86 mL, 1.8 eq) was added dropwise over 10 min. The reaction mixture was stirred for additional 30 min, and then heated at 60°C for 12 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo, and water (300 mL) and EtOAc (100 mL) were added. The resulting mixture was stirred at 25°C for 30 min. The organic phase became brown, and the aqueous was green with insoluble materials. The whole mixture was filtered through Celite and washed with EtOAc (100 mL x 3). The organic layer was separated, washed with brine (100 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to give a residue. The residue was purified by column chromatography (Si02, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 10/1 to 3/1) to give methyl 2-bromo-5-chloro-3-methoxybenzoate (16 g, 57.24 mmol, 65.0% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl , 400 MHz): d 7.28 (d, / = 2.4 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (d, J = 2.4 Hz, 1H), 3.94 (s, 3H), 3.93 (s, 3H) ppm. To a solution of methyl 2- bromo-5-chloro-3-methoxybenzoate (10 g, 35.78 mmol, 1 eq) in DCM (300 mL) was slowly added BBr3 (26.89 g, 107.33 mmol, 10.34 mL, 3 eq) at -78°C under N2. To the reaction mixture was slowly added MeOH (100 mL), and the resulting mixture was stirred at 20°C for 30 min. It was mixed with ice-water 500 mL at 0°C, and the organic phase was separated. The aqueous was extracted with DCM (100 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (200 mL x 2), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to give a residue. The residue was purified by column chromatography (Si02, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 10/1 to 0/1) to give methyl 2-bromo-5-chloro-3 -hydroxy-benzoate (4 g, 15.07 mmol, 42.1% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (CDCl , 400 MHz): d 7.43 (d, / = 2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.20 (d, / = 2.4 Hz, 1H), 6.09 (s, 1H), 3.95 (s, 3H) ppm. To a solution of methyl 2-bromo-5-chloro-3- hydroxybenzoate (0.9 g, 3.39 mmol, 1 eq) in DMF (15 mL) and H20 (1.5 mL) were added sodium 2-chloro-2,2-difluoro-acetate (1.81 g, 11.86 mmol, 3.5 eq) and K2C03 (937.03 mg, 6.78 mmol, 2 eq) at 20°C. The reaction was stirred under argon at l00°C for 5 h. The reaction mixture was quenched by addition H20 (30 mL) at 20°C, and then the aqueous was extracted with EtOAc (15 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (20 mL x 3), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to give methyl 2-bromo-5-chloro-3-(difluoro methoxy)benzoate (750 mg, 2.38 mmol, 70.1% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): d 7.60 (d, / = 2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.37 (d, / = 2.4 Hz, 1H), 6.56 (t, / = 72.8 Hz, 1H), 3.96 (s, 3H) ppm. A mixture of methyl 2-bromo-5-chloro-3-(difluoromethoxy)benzoate (0.7 g, 2.22 mmol, 1 eq), Pin2B2 (2.82 g, 11.09 mmol, 5 eq), KOAc (544.37 mg, 5.55 mmol, 2.5 eq), and Pd(PPh3)2Cl2 (155.73 mg, 221.87 umol, 0.1 eq) in l,4-dioxane (20 mL) was degassed and purged with N2 for 3 times, and then the mixture was stirred at l20°C for 5 h under N2 atmosphere. The reaction was cooled and filtered. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to give a residue. The residue was purified by column chromatography (Si02, petroleum ether/ethyl acetate = 30/1 to 5/1) to give methyl 5-chloro-3- (difluoromethoxy)-2-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2- dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (280 mg, 772.28 umol, 34.81% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl , 400 MHz): d 7.83 (d, / = 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (s, 1H), 6.59 (t, / = 74.4 Hz, 1H), 3.91 (s, 3H), 1.43 (s, 12H) ppm. To a solution of methyl 5-chloro-3-(difluoromethoxy)-2-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2- dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (280 mg, 772.28 umol, 1 eq) and NaBH4 (87.65 mg, 2.32 mmol, 3 eq) in THF (5 mL) was added MeOH (0.5 mL) at 0°C. It was stirred at 25°C for 1 h. Then the mixture was adjusted to pH = 2-3 with HC1 (2 M) and stirred for 30 min. The resulting reaction mixture was added water (20 mL) at 0°C, and then extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (15 mL x 2), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to give a residue. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Phenomenex luna C18 250*50mm* l0 um; mobile phase: [water(0.l%TFA)-ACN];B%: 25%-55%,20min) to give 5-chloro-7- (difluoromethoxy) benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol (110 mg, 469.30 umol, 60.8% yield, 100% purity) as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-i/6, 400 MHz): d 9.36 (s, 1H), 7.41 (d, /
= 1.2 Hz, 1H), 7.39 (t, / = 74.0 Hz, 1H), 7.17 (s, 1H), 4.99 (s, 2H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 233.1 [M-H]-. HPLC: 100% (220 nm), 100% (254 nm).
Example 14: 5-Chloro-6-(difluoromethoxy)benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol
Figure imgf000121_0001
[00283] To a solution of 5-bromo-2-chlorophenol (20 g, 96.41 mmol, 1 eq) in DMF (150 mL) was added K2CO3 (26.65 g, 192.82 mmol, 2 eq) and Mel (16.42 g,
115.69 mmol, 7.20 mL, 1.2 eq). The mixture was stirred at 55°C for 3 h. Water (1000 mL) was added and the mixture was extracted with petroleum ether (300 mL x 3). The combined organics were washed with brine (200 mL x 2), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. Compound 4-bromo-l-chloro-2-methoxybenzene (20 g, crude) was obtained as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-<i6, 400 MHz): d 7.37 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.33 (d, / = 2.0 Hz, 1H), 7.14 (dd, / = 8.4 Hz, 2.0 Hz, 1H), 3.88 (s, 3H) ppm. To a solution of 4-bromo-l-chloro-2-methoxybenzene (20 g, 90.30 mmol, 12.27 mL, 1 eq) in TFA (200 mL) was added 6,7,8,9-tetrazatricyclodecane (HMTA, 18.99 g, 135.45 mmol, 25.32 mL, 1.5 eq). The mixture was stirred at 80°C for 16 h. Water (200 mL) was added and the mixture was extracted with EtOAc (80 mL x 3). The combined organics were concentrated in vacuo. There were some solid formed. The mixture was filtered, and the filtrate was washed with aqueous NaHCCL to pH=7. The organic layer was separated and washed with brine (50 mL x 2), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. Compound 2-bromo-5-chloro-4-methoxy benzaldehyde (15 g, crude) was obtained as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz): d 10.04 (s, 1H), 7.84 (s, 1H), 7.55 (s, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H) ppm. To a solution of 2-bromo-5-chloro-4- methoxybenzaldehyde (5 g, 20.04 mmol, 1 eq) in DCM (30 mL) was added BBr3 (12.55 g, 50.10 mmol, 4.83 mL, 2.5 eq) at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 4 h. Water (2 mL) was added and there were some solid formed. The mixture was filtered, and the filter cake was washed with H20 (10 mL). The filter cake was dried in vacuo.
Compound 2-bromo-5-chloro-4-hydroxybenzaldehyde (4 g, crude) was obtained as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz): d 11.90 (s, 1H), 9.98 (s, 1H), 7.81 (s, 1H), 7.28 (s, 1H) ppm. To a solution of 2-bromo-5-chloro-4-hydroxybenzaldehyde (1 g, 4.25 mmol, 1 eq) in MeCN (10 mL) and H20 (4 mL) was added a solution of KOH (2.38 g, 42.47 mmol, 10 eq) in H20 (2 mL). The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 30 minutes. Then to the mixture was added diethyl (bromodifluoromethyl)phosphonate (1.70 g, 6.37 mmol, 1.5 eq). It was stirred at 0°C for 1 h and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 4). The combined organics were washed with brine (5 mL x 2), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. Compound 2-bromo-5-chloro-4-(difluoromethoxy)benzaldehyde (0.4 g, crude) was obtained as a yellow gum. 1H NMR (DMSO-<i6, 400 MHz): d 10.09 (s, 1H), 7.97 (s, 1H), 7.83 (s, 1H), 7.56 (t, / = 73.2 Hz, 1H) ppm. A mixture of 2-bromo-5- chloro-4-(difluoromethoxy) benzaldehyde (0.4 g, 1.40 mmol, 1 eq), 4, 4, 4', 4', 5, 5, 5', 5'- octamethyl-2,2'-bi(l,3,2-dioxaborolane) (1.78 g, 7.01 mmol, 5 eq), KOAc (343.79 mg, 3.50 mmol, 2.5 eq) and Pd(dppf)Cl2 (57.21 mg, 70.06 umol, 0.05 eq) in l,4-dioxane (5 mL) was degassed and purged with N2 for 3 times, and then the mixture was stirred at l20°C for 5 h under N2 atmosphere. The reaction mixture was filtered through a pad of celite. Then the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by prep- HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water (0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: l5%-45%, lOmin). Compound 5-chloro-4-(difluoromethoxy)-2- (4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzaldehyde (0.08 g, 240.58 umol, 17.2% yield) was obtained as a white solid. 'H NMR (DMSO-c/r,, 400 MHz): d 10.26 (s, 1H), 8.09 (s, 1H), 7.56 (s, 1H), 7.49 (t, / = 73.2 Hz, 1H), 1.35 (s, 12H) ppm. To a solution of 5-chloro-4-(difluoromethoxy)-2-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-l,3,2-dioxaborolan-2 - yl)benzaldehyde (0.08 g, 240.58 umol, 1 eq) in MeOH (10 mL) was added NaBH4 (27.30 mg, 721.73 umol, 3 eq). The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 10 minutes. HC1 (2N, 10 mL) was added dropwise and concentrated in vacuo to remove the organic solvent. The mixture was extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organics were washed with brine (10 mL), dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um;
mobile phase: [water (0.1 %TFA)-ACN]; B%: 35%-50%, lOmin). Compound 5-chloro-6- (difluoromethoxy)-l -hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborole (7.8 mg, 33.08 umol, 13.8% yield) was obtained as a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-<i6, 400 MHz): d 9.41 (s, 1H), 7.70 (s, 1H), 7.66 (s, 1H), 7.27 (t, J = 73.2 Hz, 2H), 4.98 (s, 2H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 233.0 [M- H]\ HPLC: 99.4% (220 nm), 100% (254 nm).
Example 15: 5-Chloro-6-(cyclobutylamino)benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol
Figure imgf000123_0001
[00284] To a mixture of 6-amino-5-chlorobenzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol (0.1 g, 545.26 umol, 1 eq) and cyclobutanone (191.08 mg, 2.73 mmol, 203.71 uL, 5 eq) and HOAc (98.23 mg, 1.64 mmol, 93.55 uL, 3 eq) in DCE (3 mL) was added NaBH3CN (85.66 mg, 1.36 mmol, 2.5 eq) in one portion at 20°C. The mixture was stirred at 20°C for 15 hr. Ice-water (2 mL) was added to the mixture. The mixture was concentrated in reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: Nano-micro
Kromasil C18 l00*30mm 5um; mobile phase: [water (0.l%TFA)-ACN]; B%: 35%-60%, 10 min) and then 0.5 ml 2 N HC1 added, the eluent was lyophilized to afford 5-chloro-6- (cyclobutylamino)benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol (54 mg, 223.60 umol, 41.0% yield) as yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-<fc, 400 MHz): d 7.33 (s, 1H), 6.98 (s, 1H), 4.83 (s, 2H), 3.88-3.85 (m, 1H), 2.37-2.32 (m, 2H), 1.98-1.93 (m, 2H), 1.76-1.71 (m, 2H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 236.0 [M-H]\ HPLC: 98.34% (220 nm), 100% (254 nm).
Example 16: 7-Chloro-6-(ethylamino)benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol
Figure imgf000123_0002
[00285] To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(7-chloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6- yl)carbamate (0.4 g, 1.41 mmol, 1 eq) in DMF (4 mL) was added NaH (169.29 mg, 4.23 mmol, 60% purity, 3 eq) in portions at 0°C. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h and then CH3CH2I (330.07 mg, 2.12 mmol, 169.27 uL, 1.5 eq) was added. The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 0.5 h and quenched by addition of saturated aqueous NH4Cl (10 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (10 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (10 mL x 3), dried over anhydrous Na2S04, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep-HPLC (column: x-chargel50*25mm*5um; mobile phase: [water (0.l%TLA)-ACN]; B%: 40%-70%,l0min). Compound tert-butyl N-(7-chloro -l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)-N-ethyl-carbamate (321 mg, 1.03 mmol, 73.02% yield) was obtained as a yellow solid. 'H NMR (DMSO-c/r,, 400 MHz): d 9.18 (s, 1H), 7.42 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.37 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 5.00 (s, 2H), 3.68-3.61 (m, 1H), 3.45-3.40 (m, 1H), 1.46-1.27 (m, 9H), 1.07-0.99 (m, 3H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 256.0 [M+H-56]+. HPLC: 97.63% (220 nm), 90.3% (254 nm). To a mixture of tert-butyl N-(7-chloro-l-hydroxy-3H-2,l-benzoxaborol-6-yl)-N-ethyl-carbamate (260 mg, 834.49 umol, 1 eq ) in EtOAc (5 mL) was added HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 4.17 mL, 20 eq) in one portion at 25 °C. The mixture was stirred at 25 °C for 1 h and concentrated under reduced pressure. Compound 7-chloro-6-(ethylamino)benzo[c][l,2]oxaborol-l(3H)-ol HC1 salt (172 mg) was obtained as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-ί/ό, 400 MHz): d 7.20 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H), 6.95 (d, / = 7.2 Hz, 1H), 5.25 (broad s, 3H), 4.87 (s, 2H), 3.19 (q, / = 7.2 Hz, 2H), 1.17 (t, / = 7.2 Hz, 3H) ppm. MS (ESI): m/z = 212.0 [M+H]+. HPLC: 100.00% (220 nm), 100.00% (254 nm).
Section III: Biological Materials and Methods Example 1. Fungal and oomycetal isolates
[00286] The isolates of Aspergillus flavus NRRL 3518 and Rhizoctonia solani NRRL 66082 were obtained from USDA Agricultural Research Service Culture
Collection. The collection of Colletotrichum sublineolum LSP270 was gifted by Dr.
Louis Prom at USDA-ARS Crop Germplasm Research in College Station, TX. The isolates of Botrytis cinerea B16, Botrytis cinerea B17, Candida albicans was obtained from the Plant Pathology and Environmental Microbiology Department at The
Pennsylvania State University, University Park, PA. The Alternaria solani isolate was kindly gifted by Dr. Inga Meadows at The Department of Entomology and Plant
Pathology, Mountain Research Station in North Carolina State University, Waynesville, NC. The collection of Mycosphaerella fijiensis 11CR-33 was given by Dr. Jean Ristaino at the Department of Plant Pathology in North Carolina State University, Raleigh, NC. The isolates of Botrytis cinerea B05.10, Fusarium oxysporumf. sp. cubense TR4, and Phytophthora capsid were obtained from the Texas A&M Agrilife Research, College Station, TX.
Example 2. Fungal and oomycetal inoculum preparation
[00287] Unless specified, most of the organisms were maintained on potato dextrose agar (PDA), and spores can be isolated from the cultures after 1-2 weeks of incubation at room temperature (20-22°C) with 12 hours fluorescent light (Philips, F40LW) and l2hours blacklight (Philips, F40T12) photoperiod. The final concentrations of all inocula were 1 x 105 CFU/mL.
[00288] Mycosphaerella fijiensis: Briefly, mycelial cultures of M. fijiensis isolates 11CR-33 grown on PDA medium were macerated in water, and 1-5 mL of the resulting suspension was pipetted onto plates of modified V8 medium (0.2g/L CaC03, 100 mL/L V8 juice and 20g/L Difco agar). Cultures were incubated at 20°C under continuous, cool- white fluorescent and black light. After 5-7 days, sporulation plates were stimulated to produce conidia by adding 2 mL water and brushing the plates with a paint brush or cell spreader and removing the resulting suspension. After another 5-7 days, conidia were harvested in the same way, adding 2 mL 0.05% Tween 20 solution, brushing the plates to dislodge spores, and removing the spore suspension by pipetting. Spores were diluted in half strength broth medium.
[00289] Rhizoctonia solani: due to insufficient spore obtained from these fungi, inocula were prepared as mycelium visible fragments. In brief, fungal mycelium grown on agar media were cut into lxlmm pieces and cultured in autoclaved broth medium (such as PDB and V8). After 3-7 days of incubation at 22-24°C, mycelia were harvested by filtering through one layer of Miracloth. The mycelia were homogenated in half strength of broth medium using household blender for 10 seconds and filtered through one layer Miracloth. The resultant visible fragments were diluted in half strength broth medium. [00290] Fusarium oxysporum f. sp. cubense: the isolate of Fusarium oxysporum f. sp. cubense TR4 was maintained on V8 agar (20% - 200 mL V8 juice, 2 g CaC03, 15 g Agar, 800 mL distilled water. Spore suspensions were prepared in half strength PDB broth medium with 0.1% Tween 20.
Example 3. In vitro antifungal and anti-oomycetal efficacy of boron-based molecules
[00291] A number of boron-based compounds were stocked in DMSO with the concentration of 5000 pg/mL (stored at -20°C). The stock solutions were further diluted into sterile half strength broth media in the in vitro assay, in which DMSO final concentration is not greater than 1% (v/v).
[00292] The minimal inhibitory concentrations (MICs) for individual compounds were determined by following a modified broth microdilution protocol. The studies were performed in flat bottom, 96-well microtiter plates (Greiner Bio-One).
[00293] The individual MICs were determined in triplicate in a final volume of 0.2 mL/well with antifungal concentrations of 0.2 - 25 pg/mL (8 serial dilutions down from 25 pg/mL [25, 12.5, 6.25, 3.13, 1.56, 0.78, 0.39 and 0.20 pg/mL]; control studies with 0 pg/mL of compounds were performed in parallel for each plate). Plates sealed with clear polyester film (VWR) were incubated at a temperature of about 22°C. The progress of fungal growth was monitored at 72 hours. The MICs were determined as the lowest antifungal concentrations that inhibited fungal growth by greater than 95% (determined as relative absorbance using the Bio-Tek® Synergy™ Hl microplate reader at 600 nm) relative to the corresponding antifungal-free control.
[00294] The MIC results and inhibition results of the antifungal screening are shown in FIG. 3A-3TT.
Example 4. In vitro antibacterial efficacy of boron-based molecules
[00295] A number of boron-based compounds were stocked in DMSO with the concentration of 5000 pg/mL (stored at -20°C). The stock solutions were further diluted into sterile half strength broth media in the in vitro assay, in which DMSO final concentration is not greater than 1% (v/v). [00296] Escherichia coli (E coli) and Agrobacterium tumefaciens (A. tumefaciens) were used in antibacterial screening. The final concentration of bacterial in each well was 0.001 OD600.
[00297] The inhibition rates (%) for individual compounds were determined by following a modified broth microdilution protocol. The studies were performed in flat bottom, 96-well microtiter plates (Greiner Bio-One). The individual inhibition rates were determined in triplicate in a final volume of 0.2 mL/well with antibacterial concentration of 25 pg/mL; control studies with 0 pg/mL of compounds were performed in parallel for each plate). Plates sealed with clear polyester film (VWR) were incubated at a temperature of about 22°C. The progress of bacterial growth was monitored at 48 hours. The inhibition rates were determined using the following formula: inhibition rate % = (OD600 of Control- OD600 of compound)/OD600 of Control * 100. (determined as relative absorbance using the Bio-Tek® Synergy™ Hl microplate reader at 600 nm) relative to the corresponding antifungal-free control.
[00298] The MIC results and inhibition results of the antibacterial screening are shown in FIG. 3A-3TT.
[00299] In one aspect, the present invention relates to benzoxaborole formulations comprising a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, or the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond. The carrier is a solid or a liquid.
[00300] In accordance with another aspect of the present invention, a method of using benzoxaborole formulations for phytopathogenic compositions comprises administering the formulation to crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, plant propagation material, in need thereof. The composition comprises a benzoxaborole, a non-ionic surfactant or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier. At least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, or the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond. The carrier is a solid or a liquid.
[00301] In a preferred embodiment, the carrier is a liquid, wherein the liquid carrier is a mixture comprising more than one suitable liquid carrier. In another preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent or at least one alcohol selected from the group consisting of: C1-C15 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1- propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof. In another preferred embodiment, the liquid carrier comprises at least one protic solvent and at least one aprotic solvent.
[00302] Preferred non-ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, high molecular weight polymers, polycondensates of ethylene oxide with fatty alcohols or with fatty acids or with fatty amines, substituted phenols (in particular alkylphenols or arylphenols such as mono- and di-(polyoxyalkylene alkylphenol), polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphated tristyrylphenols and polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphoric esters of alcohols or phenols, amine ethoxylates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil (for example PEG 40 castor oil hydrogenated), sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates (for example polysorbate 20), sorbitan fatty acid esters such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan monolaurates, non-ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary alcohol ethoxylates, nonylphenol ethoxylates, octylphenol ethoxylates, fatty alcohol ethoxylates, alkyl phenol ethoxylates, castor oil based ethoxylates, fatty acid ethoxylates, EO-PO block co-polymers, acrylic co-polymers, styrene acrylic polymers, polyalkylene oxide block copolymers, sorbitan(ol) ester ethoxylates, sarcosinates, alkyl polysaccrharides, alkyl amine ethoxylates, amine oxides, siliconics, ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, and propoxylated and non-ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers.
[00303] Preferred ionic surfactants include, but are not limited to, alkyl ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether sulphates, condensed naphthalene sulfonates and salts, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blends, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulfonate, sodium alkylnapthalene formaldehyde condensates, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acids, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic salts, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic blends, fatty alcohol sulphates, alkyl ether carboxylic acids, alkyl ether carboxylic salts, alkyl ether sulphates, monosulphosuccinates, polysulphosuccinates, alkyl phosphates, alkyl benzene sulphonic acids, alkyl benzene sulphonic salts, lignosulphonates and salts, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, and alpha olefin sulphonates.
[00304] Formulations of benzoxaboroles comprising different classes of surfactants and carriers have not been previously contemplated. The unpredictable formulations are useful in agriculture.
[00305] In some preferred embodiments of the present invention, the applied formulation has a pH of 5-10. In other preferred embodiments of the present invention, the applied formulation has a pH of 5.5-8.
[00306] In preferred embodiments of the present invention, the formulation is 0.1— 60 % w/v (or w/w) benzoxaborole if the carrier is a liquid. In a feature of this
embodiment, the formulation is 1-60% w/w (or w/w) benzoxaborole.
[00307] In preferred embodiments of the present invention, the formulation is 10 - 80 % w/v(or w/w) benzoxaborole if the carrier is a solid.
[00308] In preferred embodiments of the present invention, the formulation includes at least 0.01% w/w non-ionic surfactant or non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture and can include up to 20% w/w non-ionic surfactant or non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture.
[00309] In preferred embodiments of the present invention, the surfactant comprises at least one of a fatty alcohol ethoxylate, alkyl phenol ethoxylate, castor oil based ethoxylate, fatty acid ethoxylate, a polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate (for example polysorbate 20), a sorbitan fatty acid ester such as sorbitan monolaurate and sorbitan monostearate, a polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan monolaurate, EO- PO block co-polymer, acrylic co-polymer, styrene acrylic polymer, sorbitan(ol) ester ethoxylate, sarcosinate, alkyl polysaccharide, alkyl amine ethoxylate, amine oxide, siliconics, graft and/or comb polymer (ethoxylated or propoxylated and non ethoxylated), alkyl ether phosphate, alkyl phenol ether phosphate, alkyl phenol ether sulphate, a calcium alkylaryl sulphonate, condensed naphthalene sulfonate and/or salt, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blend, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acid/salt and their blends, fatty alcohol sulphate, alkyl ether carboxylic acid and/or salt, alkyl ether sulphate, mono- and/or polysulphosuccinate, alkyl phosphate, alkyl benzene sulphonic acid and/or salt, lignosulphonate and/or salt, and alpha olefin sulphonate. In another preferred embodiment, the surfactant is at least one of a(n): amine ethoxylates, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil, sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, non-ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary alcohol ethoxylates, nonylphenol ethoxylates, or octylphenol ethoxylates.
[00310] In preferred embodiments of the present invention, the formulation additionally includes an antioxidant.
[00311] In other preferred embodiments of the present invention, the formulation can include combinations of active ingredients, biologies, extracts, adjuvants,
antioxidants, or other additives.
[00312] An applied formulation may be obtained by diluting the formulation. The formulation may be diluted into water to obtain the applied formulation. An applied formulation can be produced by diluting the formulation, then spraying, atomizing, dusting, scattering, coating, or pouring. The formulation can also be applied directly (i.e., without dilution) by spraying, atomizing, dusting, scattering, coating, or pouring.
[00313] Pathogens including fungi, bacteria, insects, parasites may be controlled using the formulations described herein for the benefit of plants. The formulations or applied formulations may be applied or administered systemically, topically, in the soil, as a seed treatment, or foliarly.
[00314] A method of reducing growth of a target fungus/bacteria/insect/pest is contemplated. In accordance with the method, a target fungus/bacteria/pest is contacted with an effective amount of the compounds described herein, and that contact is maintained for a period of time sufficient to control and/or inhibit growth of the target fungus/bacteria/pest. For example, contact is carried out by administering the
compounds described herein to the target fungus/bacteria/pest where the administration is topical, soil, seed treatment, foliar, or systemic. In some embodiments, the
administration is repeated. [00315] In another aspect of the present disclosure, the compounds described herein are used for reducing overall damage of plants and plant parts as well as losses in harvested fruits or vegetables caused by bacteria, fungi, and/or phytopathogens.
[00316] Furthermore, in another aspect, the compounds described herein, increase the overall plant health.
[00317] Furthermore, the compounds described herein, have potent microbicidal activity and can be used for control of unwanted pathogens and microorganisms, such as fungi and bacteria, in crop protection and in the protection of plant materials. One of skill in the art will understand that the term“pathogen” broadly includes causative agents of disease, such as, pathogenic bacterium, fungi, virus, or other
microorganism that can cause disease.
[00318] Wherein the described compound is a fungicide, it can be used in crop protection for control of phytopathogenic fungi. The compound can include an outstanding efficacy against a broad spectrum of phytopathogenic fungi, including soil borne pathogens, which are in particular members of the classes Plasmodiophoromycetes, Peronosporomycetes (Syn. Oomycetes), Chytridiomycetes, Zygomycetes, Ascomycetes, Basidiomycetes, and Deuteromycetes (Syn. Fungi imperfecti). Some fungicides are systemically active and can be used in plant protection as foliar, seed dressing or soil fungicide. Furthermore, the compounds are suitable for combating fungi, which inter alia infest wood or roots of plant.
[00319] Improved plant health refers to improved plant characteristics including: crop yield, more developed root system (improved root growth), improved root size maintenance, improved root effectiveness, tillering increase, increase in plant height, bigger leaf blade, less dead basal leaves, stronger tillers, greener leaf color,
photosynthetic activity, more productive tillers, enhanced plant vigor, and increased plant stand.
[00320] In one aspect, the invention includes a compound of formula (I):
Figure imgf000132_0001
wherein:
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, CF3, Et, OCH , OCF , OCFiH, CFH2, OEt, O-n-propyl, O-n-butyl, O- iso-propyl, O-sec -butyl, O-iso-butyl, O-cyclopropyl, O-cyclbutyl, C(0)H, CN, CH2OH, SR1, and S(0)R1, wherein R1 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl;
X is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, R2, OR2, OCF2H, NR22, NHR2, NH2, halogen, CO2R2, CN, OH, CH2OH, N02, C(0)H, SR2, and S(0)R2, wherein each R2 is independently selected from C1-C7 hydrocarbyl and C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl or each R2 can be taken together to form a ring;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, NO2,
C(0)H, and CO2R3, wherein R3 is selected from C1-C4 hydrocarbyl and C3-C4 cyclohydrocarbyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, R4, NR42, NHR4, NH2, NO2, CO2R4, OR4, OH, OCF2H, SR4, and S(0)R4, wherein R4 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl and C3 cyclohydrocarbyl; and
V and V’ are independently selected from the group consisting of
hydrogen and CH3, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
[00321] In another aspect, the invention includes a method for reducing or preventing an infestation by a pathogen by applying an effective amount of a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is selected from the group consisting of bacteria, microbes, fungi, and any combinations thereof. [00322] In another aspect, the invention includes a method for reducing or preventing an infestation by a pathogen by applying a compound according to any one of the above formulae, wherein the pathogen is selected from the group consisting of bacteria, microbes, fungi, and any combinations thereof.
[00323] In yet another aspect, the invention includes a method for controlling or preventing an infestation of the pathogen by treating an, plant, plant part, or plant propagation material with an effective amount of a compound according to a compound of the disclosure.
[00324] In yet another aspect, the invention includes a method for controlling or preventing an infestation of the pathogen by treating a plant, plant part, or plant propagation material with a compound according to the disclosure.
[00325] The preceding is a simplified summary to provide an understanding of some embodiments of the present disclosure. This summary is neither an extensive nor exhaustive over-view of the present disclosure and its various embodiments. The summary presents selected concepts of the embodiments of the present disclosure in a simplified form as an introduction to the more detailed description presented below. As will be appreciated, other embodiments of the present disclosure are possible utilizing, alone or in combination, one or more of the features set forth above or described in detail below.
ENUMERATED EMBODIMENTS
1. A benzoxaborole formulation composition comprising:
a benzoxaborole,
a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier, wherein at least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond, and wherein the carrier is a solid or a liquid.
The composition of enumerated embodiment 1, wherein the benzoxaborole has a structure, (lb):
Figure imgf000134_0001
wherein:
Y is selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine, and
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 1 or 2, wherein the non-ionic and ionic surfactants are independently selected from the group consisting of: high molecular weight polymers, polycondensates of ethylene oxide with fatty alcohols or with fatty acids or with fatty amines, substituted phenols (in particular alkylphenols or arylphenols such as mono- and di-(polyoxyalkylene alkylphenol), polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphated tristyrylphenols and polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphoric esters of alcohols or phenols, amine ethoxylates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil, sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, non-ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary alcohol ethoxylates, nonylphenol ethoxylates, octylphenol ethoxylates, fatty alcohol ethoxylates, alkyl phenol ethoxylates, castor oil based ethoxylates, fatty acid ethoxylates, EO-PO block co-polymers, acrylic co-polymers, styrene acrylic polymers, sorbitan(ol) ester ethoxylates, sarcosinates, alkyl polysaccrharides, alkyl amine ethoxylates, amine oxides, siliconics, ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, and propoxylated and non-ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, alkyl ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether sulphates, condensed naphthalene sulfonates and salts, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blends, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acids, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic salts, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic blends, fatty alcohol sulphates, alkyl ether carboxylic acids, alkyl ether carboxylic salts, alkyl ether sulphates, monosulphosuccinates,
polysulphosuccinates, alkyl phosphates, alkyl benzene sulphonic acids, alkyl benzene sulphonic salts, lignosulphonates and salts, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, and alpha olefin sulphonates
The composition of any ones of enumerated embodiments 1 to 3, wherein the pKa of the benzoxaborole is between 6 and 10.
The composition of any one of enumerated embodiments 1 to 4, wherein the pKa of the benzoxaborole is between 7 and 10.
The composition of any one of enumerated embodiments 1 to 5, wherein the weight/volume % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 10% to 60% w/v if the carrier is a liquid, and the weight/volume % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 10% to 80% w/v if the carrier is a solid.
The composition of any one of enumerated embodiments 1 to 6, wherein the concentration of surfactant in the benzoxaborole formulation is between 0.1% and 20% w/v.
The composition of any one of enumerated embodiments 1 to 7, further comprising an antioxidant.
The composition of any one of enumerated embodiments 1 to 8, wherein the carrier is a liquid and is selected from the group consisting of: alcohols and glycols as well as their ethers and esters, ethylene glycol monomethyl ether, benzyl alcohol, a ketone, cyclohexanone, and isophorone.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 9, wherein the carrier further comprises a second liquid selected from the group consisting of: aliphatic hydrocarbons, aromatic hydrocarbons, substituted aromatic hydrocarbons, xylene mixtures, substituted naphthalenes, substituted aliphatic hydrocarbons and limonene. The composition of enumerated embodiment 1, wherein the benzoxaborole has a structure II:
Figure imgf000136_0001
wherein:
Y is selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
L is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyl, halogen, and straight chain or branched alkyl glycol, or L may be taken together to form a ring, and
M is a metal.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 11, wherein L is hydroxide and M is a group 1 or group 2 metal.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 11 wherein L is hydroxide and M is selected from the group consisting of K, Mg, Mn, Ca, Na, Zn, Al, Cu, and Fe. The composition of enumerated embodiments 13, wherein L is hydroxide, n = 1, and M is selected from the group consisting of K, Na, and Cu.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 11, wherein L is hydroxide, n = 2, and M is selected from the group consisting of Cu, Mg, Mn, Ca, and Zn.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 11, wherein L is hydroxide, n = 3, and M is selected from the group consisting of Cu, Mn, and Al.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 11, wherein L is fluoride and M is a group 1 or group 2 metal.
The composition of enumerated embodiments 11, wherein L is fluoride and M is selected from the group consisting of K, Na, and NH4. 19. The composition of any one of enumerated embodiments 1 to 18, further comprising an aqueous diluent.
20. The composition of enumerated embodiments 19, wherein the aqueous diluent has a pH between about 5.5 and 9.5.
21. The composition of any one of enumerated embodiments 20, wherein the aqueous diluent has a pH between about 6 and 8.
22. A method of controlling phytopathogenic diseases on plants or plant propagation material thereof according to enumerated embodiments 1, which comprises applying to said composition in an effective amount.
[00326] While this specification contains many specific implementation details, these should not be construed as limitations on the scope of any invention or on the scope of what may be claimed, but rather as descriptions of features that may be specific to particular implementations of particular inventions. Certain features that are described in this specification in the context of separate implementations can also be implemented in combination in a single implementation. Conversely, various features that are described in the context of a single implementation can also be implemented in multiple implementations separately or in any suitable sub-combination. Moreover, although features may be described above as acting in certain combinations and even initially claimed as such, one or more features from a claimed combination can in some cases be excised from the combination, and the claimed combination may be directed to a sub combination or variation of a sub-combinations.
[00327] Particular implementations of the subject matter have been described. Other implementations, alterations, and permutations of the described implementations are within the scope of the following claims as will be apparent to those skilled in the art. For example, the actions recited in the claims can be performed in a different order and still achieve desirable results.
[00328] Accordingly, the above description of example implementations does not define or constrain this disclosure. Other changes, substitutions, and alterations are also possible without departing from the spirit and scope of this disclosure.

Claims

CLAIMS We claim:
1. A benzoxaborole formulation composition comprising:
a benzoxaborole,
a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a carrier,
wherein at least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond, and wherein the carrier is a solid or a liquid.
2. The composition of claim 1, wherein the benzoxaborole has a structure (lb):
Figure imgf000138_0001
wherein:
Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; and
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
3. The composition of claim 1 or claim 2, wherein the benzoxaborole has a structure
(Ic):
Figure imgf000138_0002
wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
4. The composition of claim 2, wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, and hydrogen.
5. The composition of claim 3, wherein Y is selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, and hydrogen.
6. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 5, wherein the benzoxaborole is:
Figure imgf000139_0001
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
7. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 6, wherein the non-ionic and ionic surfactants are independently selected from the group consisting of: high molecular weight polymers, polycondensates of ethylene oxide with fatty alcohols or with fatty acids or with fatty amines, substituted phenols (in particular alkylphenols or arylphenols such as mono- and di-(polyoxyalkylene alkylphenol), polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphate tristyrylphenols and polycondensates of ethylene oxide with phosphoric esters of alcohols or phenols, amine ethoxylates, castor oil ethoxylates and polyethylene glycol derivatives of hydrogenated castor oil, sorbitan fatty acid ester ethoxylates, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurates, sorbitan fatty acid esters, sorbitan monolaurate, sorbitan monostearate, polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene sorbitan monolaurates, non ionic ethoxylates, branched and unbranched secondary alcohol ethoxylates, nonylphenol ethoxylates, octylphenol ethoxylates, fatty alcohol ethoxylates, alkyl phenol ethoxylates, castor oil based ethoxylates, fatty acid ethoxylates, EO-PO block co-polymers, acrylic co-polymers, styrene acrylic polymers, polyalkylene oxide block copolymers, sorbitan(ol) ester ethoxylates, sarcosinates, alkyl polysaccrharides, alkyl amine ethoxylates, amine oxides, siliconics, ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, propoxylated and non-ethoxylated Graft & Comb polymers, alkyl ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether phosphates, alkyl phenol ether sulphates, condensed naphthalene sulfonates and salts, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulphonate blends, sodium alkyl naphthalene sulfonate, sodium alkylnapthalene formaldehyde condensates, sodium naphthalene sulphonate condensate, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic acids, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic salts, aromatic hydrocarbon sulfonic blends, fatty alcohol sulphates, alkyl ether carboxylic acids, alkyl ether carboxylic salts, alkyl ether sulphates,
monosulphosuccinates, polysulphosuccinates, alkyl phosphates, alkyl benzene sulphonic acids, alkyl benzene sulphonic salts, lignosulphonates and salts, alkylaryl sulphonates, alkylbenzene sulphonates, calcium alkylaryl sulphonates, and alpha olefin sulphonates.
8. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 7, wherein the pKa of the
benzoxaborole is between 6 and 10.
9. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 8, wherein the pKa of the
benzoxaborole is between 6 and 8.
10. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 9, wherein the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 5% to 60% w/w if the carrier is a liquid, and the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 20% to 99.9% w/w if the carrier is a solid.
11. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 10, wherein the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 10% to 50% w/w if the carrier is a liquid, and the weight/weight % of benzoxaborole in the benzoxaborole formulation is 20% to 80% w/w if the carrier is a solid.
12. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 11, wherein the concentration of
surfactant in the benzoxaborole formulation is between 0.1% and 35% w/w.
13. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 12, further comprising an antioxidant.
14. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 13, wherein the carrier is a liquid and comprises a solvent selected from the group consisting of: a protic solvent, water, Ci-Ci5 branched alcohols, C1-C15 linear alcohols, benzyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cetyl alcohol, lauryl alcohol, 2-propanol, methanol, n-decanol, 1 -propanol, ethanol, l-hexanol, isobutyl alcohol, n-octanol, 1 -butanol, pentanol, cyclohexanol, and mixtures thereof, alcohols, ethylene glycol monomethyl ether , or a mixture thereof.
15. The composition of claim 14, wherein the carrier further comprises a second liquid carrier selected from the group consisting of: an aprotic solvent, a ketone, cyclohexanone, isophorone, or N-methyl-2-pyrrolidone.
16. The composition of any one of claims lto 15, wherein the carrier comprises a
mixture of a protic solvent and an aprotic solvent, preferably wherein the aprotic solvent is polar.
17. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 13, wherein the carrier is a solid.
18. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 17, wherein the benzoxaborole
formulation is an emulsion concentrate (EC), a suspension concentrate (SC), a wettable powder (WP), a water dispersible granule (WDG), or a seed treatment.
19. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 18, further comprising an aqueous
diluent.
20. The composition of claim 19, wherein the aqueous diluent has a pH between
about 5.5 and 9.5.
21. The composition of claim 19, wherein the aqueous diluent has a pH between
about 6 and 8.
22. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 21, further comprising at least one
fungicide selected from the group consisting of: carbendazim, thiabendazole, thiophanate, thiophanate-methyl, diethofencarb, zoxamide, ethaboxam, pencycuron, flupicolide, flutolanil, fluopyram, fluxapyroxad, penthiopyrad, benodanil, mepronil, isofetamid, fenfuram, carboxin, oxycarboxin, thifluzamide, benzovindiflupyr, bixafen, furametpyr, isopyrazam, penflufen, sedaxane, boscalid, benomyl, fuberidazole, diflumetorim, tolfenpyrad, azoxystrobin, coumoxystrobin, enoxastrobin, flufenoxystrobin, picoxystrobin, pyraoxystrobin, mandestrobin, pyraclostrobin, pyrametostrobin, triclopyricarb, kresoxim-methyl, trifloxystrobin, dimeoxystrobin, fenamistrobin, methominostrobin, orysastrobin, famoxadone, fluoxastrobin, fenamidone, pyribencarb, cyazofamid, amisulbrom, binapacryl, meptyldinocap, dinocap, fluazinam, fentin chloride, fentin acetate, fentin hydroxide, silthiofam, ametoctradin, cyprodinil, mepanipyrim, pyrimethanil, kasugamycin, quinoxyfen, proquinazid, fenpiclonil, fludioxonil, chlozolinate, dimethachlone, iprodione, procymidone, vinclozolin, triforine, pyrifenox, pyrisoxazole, fenarimol, nuarimol, imazalil, oxpoconazole, pefurazoate, prochloraz, triflumizole, azaconazole, bitertanol, bromuconazole, cyproconazole, diniconazole, epoxiconazole, etanconazole, fenbuconazole, fluquinconazole, flusilazole, flutriafol, hexaconazole, imibenconazole, ipconazole, metconazole, myclobutanil, penconazole, propiconazole, simeconazole, tebuconazole, tetraconazole, triadimefon, triadimenol, triticonazole, prothioconazole, aldimorph, dodemorph, fenpropimorph, tridemorph, fenpropidin, piperalin, spiroxamine, fenhexamid, fenpyrazamine, pyributicarb, naftifine, terbinafine, validamycin, polyoxin, dimethomorph, flumorph, pyrimorph, benthiavalicarb, iprovalicarb, valifenalate, mandipropamid, ferbam, macozeb, maneb, metiram, propineb, thiram, zineb, ziram, captan, captafol, folpet, dichlofluanid, tolylfluanid, and chlorothalonil.
23. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 22, further comprising at least one
insecticide/nematicide selected from the group consisting of: avermectin group, such as abamectin; carbamate group, such as, aldicarb, thiadicarb, carbofuran, carbosulfan, oxamyl, aldoxycarb, ethoprop, methomyl, benomyl, alanycarb; and organophosphorus group, such as, fenamiphos, fensulfothion, terbufos, fosthiazate, dimethoate, phosphocarb, dichlofenthion, isamidofos, fosthietan, isazofos ethoprophos, cadusafos, terbufos, chlorpyrifos, dichlofenthion, heterophos, isamidofos, mecarphon, phorate, thionazin, triazophos, diamidafos, fosthietan, phosphamidon, and dichloropropene.
24. The composition of any one of claims 1 to 23, further comprising at least one
insecticide selected from the group consisting of: a phenylpyrazole group, such as ethiprole and fipronil; a pyrethroid group, such as acrinathrin, allethrin, bifenthrin, bioallenthrin, bioresmethrin, cycloprothrin, cyfluthrin, cyhalothrin, cypermethrin, cyphenothrin, deltamethrin, esfenvalerate, etofenprox, fenpropathrin, fenvalerate, flucythrinate, flumethrin, halfenprox, imiprothrin, kadethrin, permethrin, prallethrin, pyrethrins, resmethrin, silafluofen, tefluthrin, tetramethrin,
tetramethrin, tralomethrin, and transfluthrin; and a neonicotinoid group: such as acetamiprid, clothianidin, dinotefuran, imidacloprid, nitenpyram, thiacloprid, and thiamethoxam; and a spinosyn group: such as spinetoram and spinosad.
25. A method of controlling a phytopathogenic disease on crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material comprising applying an effective amount of the composition of any one of claims 1 to 24 to said crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material.
26. A method of controlling a phytopathogenic disease on crops, seeds, plants, plant parts, or plant propagation material comprising applying an effective amount of the composition of any one of claims 1 to 24, wherein said application is topical, to the soil, foliar, a foliar spray, systemic, a seed coating, a soil drench, directly in-furrow dipping, drenching, soil drenching, spraying, atomizing, irrigating, evaporating, dusting, fogging, broadcasting, foaming, painting, spreading-on, watering (drenching), and/or drip irrigating.
27. A benzoxaborole compound represented by formula (I):
Figure imgf000143_0001
wherein:
W is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, CF3, Ethyl, OCH , OCF , OCF2H, CFH2, OEthyl, O-n-propyl, O-n- butyl, O-iso-propyl, O-sec-butyl, O-iso-butyl, O-cyclopropyl, O- cyclbutyl, C(0)H, CN, CH2OH, SR1, and S(0)R1, wherein R1 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl;
X is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, R2, OR2, OCF2H, NR2 2, NHR2, NH2, halogen, C02R2, CN, OH, CH2OH, N02, C(0)H, SR2, and S(0)R2, wherein each R2 is independently selected from C1-C7 hydrocarbyl and C3-C6 cyclohydrocarbyl or each R2 can be taken together to form a ring; Y is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, CH3, N02,
C(0)H, and CO2R3, wherein R3 is selected from C1-C4 hydrocarbyl and C3-C4 cyclohydrocarbyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, R4, NR42, NHR4, NH2, N02, CO2R4, OR4, OH, OCF2H, SR4, and S(0)R4, wherein R4 is selected from C1-C3 hydrocarbyl and C3 cyclohydrocarbyl; and
V and V’ are independently selected from the group consisting of
hydrogen and CH3,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
28 A benzoxaborole compound represented by formula Ial:
Figure imgf000144_0001
wherein:
Ri is equal to R2, or Ri is not equal to R2, and
Ri and/or R2 are selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, and pentyl, or
Ri and R2 are taken together to form a 3 to 6 membered ring; and each Xa is independently selected from the group consisting of: fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine,
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
29. A benzoxaborole compound represented by formula Iall:
Figure imgf000145_0001
wherein: each R12 or R13 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, pentyl, C1-C7 hydrocarbyl, C3-C6 cyclohydrocabyl, - CH2CºCR4 a , -CH2CºCPh, CH2CºCCH2Ph, and C1-C7 hydrocarbyl having 1-15 R4 a substitutions; or R12 and R13 taken together, form a 3 to 6 membered ring with the nitrogen atom to which they are bonded to; each Xa is independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; each Ya is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine; and each R4 a is independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
30. The benzoxaborole compound of claim 27, wherein the benzoxaborole compound is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000145_0002
Figure imgf000146_0001
ı44
Figure imgf000147_0001

Figure imgf000148_0001

Figure imgf000149_0001

Figure imgf000150_0001

Figure imgf000151_0001

Figure imgf000152_0001
150 , or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
31. The benzoxaborole compound of claim 29, wherein at least one of R12 and R13 is - CH2CºCR4 a, wherein R4 a is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl.
32. The benzoxaborole compound of claim 29, wherein at least one of R12 and R13 is - CH2CºCPh or CH2CºCCH2Ph.
33. The benzoxaborole compound of claim 28, wherein the compound is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000153_0001
Figure imgf000154_0001
, or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
34. An emulsion concentrate formulation composition comprising:
a benzoxaborole,
a non-ionic surfactant, or a non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and a liquid carrier, wherein at least one of the non-ionic surfactant, the non-ionic and ionic surfactant mixture, and the liquid carrier comprise a Lewis base or a N-H or O-H bond.
35. The composition of claim 34, wherein the benzoxaborole is:
Figure imgf000155_0001
or a salt, stereoisomer, enantiomer, or tautomer thereof.
36. The composition of claim 34 or 35, wherein the liquid carrier comprises a protic solvent.
37. The composition of any one of claims 34 to 36 wherein the liquid carrier
comprises a mixture of a protic solvent and an aprotic solvent.
38. The composition of claim 37, wherein the aprotic solvent is a polar aprotic solvent.
39. The composition of claim 38, further comprising a non-polar aprotic solvent.
40. A method for reducing, preventing, ameliorating, or inhibiting an infestation by a pathogen comprising applying a compound according to any one of claims 1-39, wherein the pathogen is selected from a group consisting of: insects, nematodes, bacteria, microbes, fungi, protozoa, viruses, and parasites, or any combinations thereof.
41. The method of claim 40, wherein the compound is applied to an animal, a plant, a plant part, seeds, or plant propagation material.
PCT/US2018/063389 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof WO2019108982A1 (en)

Priority Applications (8)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2020548880A JP2021505660A (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxabolol compounds and their formulations
BR112020010927-4A BR112020010927A2 (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 benzoxaborol compounds and formulations thereof
CA3120976A CA3120976A1 (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
MX2020005464A MX2020005464A (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof.
US15/733,157 US11834466B2 (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
AU2018375795A AU2018375795A1 (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
CN201880088201.8A CN111655035A (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
EP18883841.1A EP3716766A4 (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201762593226P 2017-11-30 2017-11-30
US62/593,226 2017-11-30
US201862743489P 2018-10-09 2018-10-09
US62/743,489 2018-10-09

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2019108982A1 true WO2019108982A1 (en) 2019-06-06

Family

ID=66665262

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2018/063389 WO2019108982A1 (en) 2017-11-30 2018-11-30 Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof

Country Status (9)

Country Link
US (1) US11834466B2 (en)
EP (1) EP3716766A4 (en)
JP (1) JP2021505660A (en)
CN (1) CN111655035A (en)
AU (1) AU2018375795A1 (en)
BR (1) BR112020010927A2 (en)
CA (1) CA3120976A1 (en)
MX (1) MX2020005464A (en)
WO (1) WO2019108982A1 (en)

Cited By (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11236115B2 (en) 2018-08-18 2022-02-01 5Metis, Inc. Solid forms of substituted benzoxaborole and compositions thereof
US11834466B2 (en) 2017-11-30 2023-12-05 5Metis, Inc. Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
WO2024094235A1 (en) 2022-11-03 2024-05-10 Univerzita Karlova Use of benzoxaborole-based compounds in therapy of diseases caused by amoebas of the naegleria genus
RU2821015C1 (en) * 2019-10-28 2024-06-17 Сумитомо Кемикал Компани, Лимитед New clothianidin compositions and methods of use thereof

Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7767657B2 (en) * 2005-02-16 2010-08-03 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Boron-containing small molecules
US20150133402A1 (en) * 2007-06-20 2015-05-14 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Boron-containing small molecules
WO2016113303A1 (en) * 2015-01-13 2016-07-21 Syngenta Participations Ag Microbiocidal benzoxaboroles
US20170000133A1 (en) * 2013-12-23 2017-01-05 Syngenta Participations Ag Benzoxaborole fungicides
WO2017195069A1 (en) 2016-05-12 2017-11-16 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oxaborole esters and uses thereof

Family Cites Families (94)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPS5512401B1 (en) 1969-03-15 1980-04-02
US4672065A (en) 1982-11-19 1987-06-09 Chevron Research Company N-substituted phenoxyacetamide fungicides
US4936901A (en) 1986-07-09 1990-06-26 Monsanto Company Formulations of water-dispersible granules and process for preparation thereof
DE4038741A1 (en) 1990-12-05 1992-06-11 Bayer Ag AGENT TO PROTECT PLANTS AGAINST MICROORGANISMS
GB9411587D0 (en) 1994-06-09 1994-08-03 Zeneca Ltd Compound, composition and use
AU683177B2 (en) 1994-06-20 1997-10-30 Premacs International Pty Limited Method for the treatment of seeds with betaines
AUPN229595A0 (en) 1995-04-12 1995-05-04 Eastman Kodak Company Integrated drive circuitry in lift print heads
BR9708314A (en) 1996-03-11 1999-08-03 Novartis Ag Pesticide
EP0975778B8 (en) 1997-04-03 2007-11-21 DeKalb Genetics Corporation Use of glyphosate resistant maize lines
AU1336200A (en) 1998-11-03 2000-05-22 Aventis Cropscience N.V. Glufosinate tolerant rice
US6333449B1 (en) 1998-11-03 2001-12-25 Plant Genetic Systems, N.V. Glufosinate tolerant rice
AU2002215363B2 (en) 2000-10-25 2006-10-12 Monsanto Technology Llc Cotton event PV-GHGT07(1445) and compositions and methods for detection thereof
US6818807B2 (en) 2001-08-06 2004-11-16 Bayer Bioscience N.V. Herbicide tolerant cotton plants having event EE-GH1
KR100454531B1 (en) 2002-05-25 2004-11-05 기영상 Anti-slip tarpaulin and method of manufacturing it
WO2004011601A2 (en) 2002-07-29 2004-02-05 Monsanto Technology, Llc Corn event pv-zmir13 (mon863) plants and compositions and methods for detection thereof
GB0225129D0 (en) 2002-10-29 2002-12-11 Syngenta Participations Ag Improvements in or relating to organic compounds
EP1567000A4 (en) 2002-12-05 2007-09-05 Monsanto Technology Llc Bentgrass event asr-368 and compositions and methods for detection thereof
ES2382804T3 (en) 2003-02-12 2012-06-13 Monsanto Technology Llc MON 88913 cotton event and compositions and procedures for its detection
EA011923B1 (en) 2003-02-20 2009-06-30 Квс Саат Аг Glyphosate tolerant sugar beet
WO2005054480A2 (en) 2003-12-01 2005-06-16 Syngenta Participations Ag Insect resistant cotton plants and methods of detecting the same
US7157281B2 (en) 2003-12-11 2007-01-02 Monsanto Technology Llc High lysine maize compositions and event LY038 maize plants
US8212113B2 (en) 2003-12-15 2012-07-03 Monsanto Technology Llc Corn plant Mon88017 and compositions and methods for detection thereof
EP2281447B1 (en) 2004-03-25 2016-07-27 Syngenta Participations AG Corn event MIR604
AU2004318788B2 (en) 2004-03-26 2011-12-22 Corteva Agriscience Llc Cry1F and Cry1Ac transgenic cotton lines and event-specific identification thereof
US7582621B2 (en) 2005-02-16 2009-09-01 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Boron-containing small molecules
ES2388548T3 (en) 2005-04-08 2012-10-16 Bayer Cropscience Nv Elite event A2704-12 and methods and cases to identify this event in biological samples
PL1871901T3 (en) 2005-04-11 2011-11-30 Bayer Bioscience Nv Elite event a5547-127 and methods and kits for identifying such event in biological samples
WO2006128570A1 (en) 2005-06-02 2006-12-07 Syngenta Participations Ag 1143-51b insecticidal cotton
WO2006128569A2 (en) 2005-06-02 2006-12-07 Syngenta Participations Ag 1143-14a, insecticidal transgenic cotton expressing cry1ab
EP1917359A2 (en) 2005-06-02 2008-05-07 Syngeta Participations AG Ce43-67b, insecticidal transgenic cotton expressing cry1ab
US20100024077A1 (en) 2005-06-02 2010-01-28 Syngenta Participations Ag Ce44-69d insecticidal cotton
EP2295587A1 (en) 2005-08-08 2011-03-16 Bayer BioScience N.V. Herbicide tolerant cotton plants and methods for identifying same
UY29761A1 (en) 2005-08-24 2007-03-30 Du Pont COMPOSITIONS THAT PROVIDE TOLERANCE TO MULTIPLE HERBICIDES AND METHODS TO USE THEM
UA96421C2 (en) 2005-08-31 2011-11-10 Монсанто Текнолоджи Ллс Nucleotide sequence encoding insecticidal proteins
EP1989313B1 (en) 2006-02-10 2016-01-13 Maharashtra Hybrid Seeds Company Limited (MAHYCO) Transgenic brinjal (solanum melongena) expressing the cryiac gene
KR20130120552A (en) 2006-02-16 2013-11-04 아나코르 파마슈티칼스 인코포레이티드 Boron-containing small molecules as anti-inflammatory agents
BRPI0711155A2 (en) 2006-05-02 2011-08-23 Anacor Pharmaceuticals Inc hydrolytically resistant boron-containing treatments and methods of use
CN101495635B (en) 2006-05-26 2017-05-17 孟山都技术有限公司 Corn plant and seed corresponding to transgenic event MON89034 and methods for detection and use thereof
ES2546255T3 (en) 2006-06-03 2015-09-22 Syngenta Participations Ag MIR162 Corn Event
US20070286822A1 (en) 2006-06-12 2007-12-13 Anacor Pharmaceuticals Inc. Compounds for the Treatment of Periodontal Disease
FR2905195B1 (en) 2006-08-23 2008-10-10 Dav Sa CONTROL MODULE, IN PARTICULAR FOR MOTOR VEHICLE
EP2066789A4 (en) 2006-09-29 2009-12-30 Anacor Pharmaceuticals Inc Crystal structure of a trna synthetase
US7928296B2 (en) 2006-10-30 2011-04-19 Pioneer Hi-Bred International, Inc. Maize event DP-098140-6 and compositions and methods for the identification and/or detection thereof
US8049071B2 (en) 2007-11-15 2011-11-01 Monsanto Technology Llc Soybean plant and seed corresponding to transgenic event MON87701 and methods for detection thereof
WO2009100188A2 (en) 2008-02-08 2009-08-13 Dow Agrosciences Llc Methods for detection of corn event das-59132
WO2009102873A1 (en) 2008-02-15 2009-08-20 Monsanto Technology Llc Soybean plant and seed corresponding to transgenic event mon87769 and methods for detection thereof
PL2247736T3 (en) 2008-02-29 2013-10-31 Monsanto Technology Llc Corn plant event mon87460 and compositions and methods for detection thereof
EP2187893A4 (en) 2008-03-06 2012-02-22 Anacor Pharmaceuticals Inc Boron-containing small molecules as anti-inflammatory agents
AU2009221793B2 (en) 2008-03-06 2015-02-19 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc Boron-containing small molecules as anti-inflammatory agents
EP2303006A2 (en) 2008-04-08 2011-04-06 Basf Se Emulsifiable concentrate
WO2010024976A1 (en) 2008-08-29 2010-03-04 Monsanto Technology Llc Soybean plant and seed corresponding to transgenic event mon87754 and methods for detection thereof
US8329989B2 (en) 2008-09-29 2012-12-11 Monsanto Technology Llc Soybean transgenic event MON87705 and methods for detection thereof
NZ593410A (en) 2008-12-16 2013-01-25 Syngenta Participations Ag Corn event 5307
WO2010110400A1 (en) 2009-03-26 2010-09-30 武田薬品工業株式会社 Heterocyclic compound
JP5762400B2 (en) 2009-03-30 2015-08-12 モンサント テクノロジー エルエルシー Rice genetic recombination event 17053 and methods of use thereof
KR101813722B1 (en) 2009-03-30 2017-12-29 몬산토 테크놀로지 엘엘씨 Transgenic rice event 17314 and methods of use thereof
JP2013526832A (en) 2009-08-19 2013-06-27 ダウ アグロサイエンシィズ エルエルシー AAD-1 event DAS-40278-9, related transgenic corn lines and their event-specific identification
RU2624025C2 (en) 2009-09-17 2017-06-30 МОНСАНТО ТЕКНОЛОДЖИ ЭлЭлСи Coi mon 87708 transgenic object and methods for its application
WO2011060199A1 (en) 2009-11-11 2011-05-19 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Boron-containing small molecules
RU2764586C2 (en) 2009-11-23 2022-01-18 Монсанто Текнолоджи Ллс Transgenic event mon 87427 of maize and relative development scale
BR112012012494A2 (en) 2009-11-24 2020-11-03 Dow Agrosciences Llc aad-12 416 soy event detection
AU2010324752B2 (en) 2009-11-24 2016-04-21 Dow Agrosciences Llc AAD-12 event 416, related transgenic soybean lines, and event-specific identification thereof
WO2011075595A1 (en) 2009-12-17 2011-06-23 Pioneer Hi-Bred International, Inc. Maize event dp-043a47-3 and methods for detection thereof
WO2011075593A1 (en) 2009-12-17 2011-06-23 Pioneer Hi-Bred International, Inc. Maize event dp-040416-8 and methods for detection thereof
DK3251678T3 (en) 2010-09-07 2021-11-22 Anacor Pharmaceuticals Inc BENZOXABOROL DERIVATIVES FOR THE TREATMENT OF BACTERIA INFECTIONS
EP2763538A2 (en) 2011-10-07 2014-08-13 Syngenta Participations AG Method for protecting useful plants or plant propagation material
US9585396B2 (en) 2013-01-30 2017-03-07 Agrofresh Inc. Volatile applications against pathogens
US8669207B1 (en) 2013-01-30 2014-03-11 Dow Agrosciences, Llc. Compounds and compositions
AU2014212576B2 (en) * 2013-01-30 2015-08-13 Agrofresh Inc. Use of benzoxaboroles as volatile antimicrobial agents on meats, plants, or plant parts
US11039617B2 (en) 2013-01-30 2021-06-22 Agrofresh Inc. Large scale methods of uniformly coating packaging surfaces with a volatile antimicrobial to preserve food freshness
US10070649B2 (en) 2013-01-30 2018-09-11 Agrofresh Inc. Volatile applications against pathogens
US11766043B2 (en) 2013-01-30 2023-09-26 Agrofresh Inc. Vaporized administration of pesticides
AR094961A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2015-09-09 Lilly Co Eli 1-HIDROXI-BENZOOXABOROLES AS ANTIPARASITARY AGENTS
WO2014173880A1 (en) 2013-04-22 2014-10-30 Syngenta Participations Ag Novel microbiocides
AU2014202928B1 (en) 2013-06-05 2014-09-11 Agrofresh Inc. Compounds and compositions
JP2015212249A (en) 2014-05-05 2015-11-26 アナコール ファーマシューティカルズ,インコーポレイテッド Compounds and nail polish
CA2954803A1 (en) 2014-05-12 2015-11-19 Agrofresh Inc. Volatile applications against pathogens
EP2982247A1 (en) 2014-08-07 2016-02-10 Omya International AG Antiseptic product, process for preparing same and its use
DK3221308T3 (en) 2014-11-21 2018-12-10 F2G Ltd Antifungals
EP3244741A1 (en) 2015-01-13 2017-11-22 Syngenta Participations AG Novel microbiocides
MA41494B1 (en) 2015-02-12 2020-10-28 Glaxosmithkline Ip No 2 Ltd Benzoxaborole compounds substituted in position 4 and associated uses
ES2758045T3 (en) 2015-02-12 2020-05-04 Agrofresh Inc Fungicidal compounds and compositions
CA2981773C (en) * 2015-04-09 2022-03-15 The Penn State Research Foundation Synergistic benzoxaborole-containing anti-fungicidal composition
US10160867B2 (en) 2015-08-06 2018-12-25 The Penn State Research Foundation Benzoxaborole-containing coating resistant to cellulose-supportable fungus
CN105712969B (en) 2016-01-27 2018-07-27 杭州科巢生物科技有限公司 The synthetic method of Wei Patawei intermediates
US10435419B2 (en) 2016-04-18 2019-10-08 Biophore India Pharmaceuticals Pvt. Ltd. Process for the preparation of tavaborole, its novel polymorphic forms and the polymorphs thereof
US20180009831A1 (en) 2016-07-06 2018-01-11 Apicore Us Llc Process for the preparation of novel polymorphic forms of 5-fluoro-1,3-dihydro-1-hydroxy-2,1- benzoxaborole
CA3120974A1 (en) 2017-11-30 2019-06-06 Boragen, Inc. Combinatorial compositions of benzoxaboroles and biologic agents
WO2019108982A1 (en) 2017-11-30 2019-06-06 Boragen, Inc. Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
BR112020015547A2 (en) 2018-02-01 2021-02-02 Boragen, Inc. benzoxaborol compositions that have a growth enhancing effect
EP3836938A4 (en) 2018-08-18 2022-05-11 Boragen, Inc. Solid forms of substituted benzoxaborole and compositions thereof
WO2020123881A1 (en) 2018-12-12 2020-06-18 Boragen, Inc. Boron containing compounds and their uses
CN111233908A (en) 2019-02-21 2020-06-05 南京农业大学 Benzoxaborol-1-ol compound and preparation method and application thereof
US20220275007A1 (en) 2019-07-30 2022-09-01 Boragen, Inc. Flow reaction process for manufacture of boron-containing agrochemicals

Patent Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7767657B2 (en) * 2005-02-16 2010-08-03 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Boron-containing small molecules
US20150133402A1 (en) * 2007-06-20 2015-05-14 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Boron-containing small molecules
US20170000133A1 (en) * 2013-12-23 2017-01-05 Syngenta Participations Ag Benzoxaborole fungicides
WO2016113303A1 (en) * 2015-01-13 2016-07-21 Syngenta Participations Ag Microbiocidal benzoxaboroles
WO2017195069A1 (en) 2016-05-12 2017-11-16 Anacor Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oxaborole esters and uses thereof

Non-Patent Citations (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
DATABASE PUBCHEM compound 26 March 2005 (2005-03-26), "1-Hydroxy-2,1-benzoxaborolane", XP055616732, retrieved from NCBI Database accession no. 403788 *
See also references of EP3716766A4

Cited By (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11834466B2 (en) 2017-11-30 2023-12-05 5Metis, Inc. Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
US11236115B2 (en) 2018-08-18 2022-02-01 5Metis, Inc. Solid forms of substituted benzoxaborole and compositions thereof
US11560393B2 (en) 2018-08-18 2023-01-24 5Metis, Inc. Solid forms of substituted benzoxaborole and compositions thereof
US12098159B2 (en) 2018-08-18 2024-09-24 5Metis, Inc. Solid forms of substituted benzoxaborole and compositions thereof
RU2821015C1 (en) * 2019-10-28 2024-06-17 Сумитомо Кемикал Компани, Лимитед New clothianidin compositions and methods of use thereof
WO2024094235A1 (en) 2022-11-03 2024-05-10 Univerzita Karlova Use of benzoxaborole-based compounds in therapy of diseases caused by amoebas of the naegleria genus

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
BR112020010927A2 (en) 2020-12-01
MX2020005464A (en) 2020-12-03
US20200385409A1 (en) 2020-12-10
US11834466B2 (en) 2023-12-05
CN111655035A (en) 2020-09-11
EP3716766A1 (en) 2020-10-07
CA3120976A1 (en) 2019-06-06
JP2021505660A (en) 2021-02-18
AU2018375795A1 (en) 2020-07-02
EP3716766A4 (en) 2021-12-22

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
AU2017242539B2 (en) Bicyclic compounds
TWI568721B (en) Fungicidal pyrazole mixtures
JP6539205B2 (en) Composition for controlling synergistic plant diseases comprising picolinic acid derivative
JP5443176B2 (en) Combination pesticide
JP2015044791A (en) Agricultural and horticultural pest control agent and method for controlling pest
US11834466B2 (en) Benzoxaborole compounds and formulations thereof
JP2010515696A (en) Agrochemical combination
CA3116622A1 (en) Pesticidal compounds
AU2018279252B2 (en) Novel pesticidal combinations
JP2010520865A5 (en)
CA3185119A1 (en) Fungicidal mixtures
WO2020171077A1 (en) Heterocyclic compound and harmful arthropod-controlling composition containing same
KR20160009657A (en) Solid forms of fungicidal pyrazoles
WO2015062353A1 (en) Fungicidal composition and the use thereof
WO2020064480A1 (en) Pesticidal mixture comprising a mesoionic compound and a biopesticide
WO2023135535A1 (en) Fungicidal mixtures comprising combination containing phthalimide fungicides
CN116456817A (en) Heterocyclic compound and harmful arthropod control composition containing same
CN108779092A (en) Nematicidal heterocycleamide
WO2022040157A1 (en) Boron containing compounds and their uses
CN113453763B (en) Ether compound and harmful arthropod control composition containing the ether compound
DK201400182U1 (en) A combination product
WO2024071393A1 (en) Heterocyclic compound and harmful arthropod-controlling composition containing same
WO2022186377A1 (en) Fused ring compound and use thereof
CN118946267A (en) Method for controlling harmful arthropods or harmful linear animals using levoambrisen analog
WO2024080330A1 (en) Sulfonamide compound and harmful-arthropod controlling composition containing same

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 18883841

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2020548880

Country of ref document: JP

Kind code of ref document: A

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2018375795

Country of ref document: AU

Date of ref document: 20181130

Kind code of ref document: A

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2018883841

Country of ref document: EP

Effective date: 20200630

REG Reference to national code

Ref country code: BR

Ref legal event code: B01A

Ref document number: 112020010927

Country of ref document: BR

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 112020010927

Country of ref document: BR

Kind code of ref document: A2

Effective date: 20200529

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 3120976

Country of ref document: CA